jtag/drivers: Add dmem driver
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2022 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @item @b{STLINK-V3PWR}
467 @* This is available standalone.
468 Beside the debugger functionality, the probe includes a SMU (source
469 measurement unit) aimed at analyzing power consumption during code
470 execution. The SMU is not supported by OpenOCD.
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3pwr}
472 @end itemize
473
474 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
475 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
476 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
477 @itemize @bullet
478 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
479 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
480 @end itemize
481
482 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
483 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
484 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
485 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
486
487 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
488 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
489 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
490 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
491 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
492
493 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
494 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
495 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
496
497 @section USB Other
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item @b{USBprog}
500 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
501
502 @item @b{USB - Presto}
503 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
504
505 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
506 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
507
508 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
509 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
510
511 @item @b{angie}
512 @* Link: @url{https://nanoxplore.org/}
513
514 @item @b{Buspirate}
515 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
516
517 @item @b{opendous}
518 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
519
520 @item @b{estick}
521 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
522
523 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
525
526 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
527 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
528 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
529 @end itemize
530
531 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
532
533 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
534 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
535 these on the market.
536
537 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
538 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
539 of USB-based ones.
540
541 @itemize @bullet
542
543 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
544 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
545
546 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
547 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
548 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
549
550 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
551 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
552
553 @item @b{Wiggler2}
554 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
555
556 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
557 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
558
559 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
560 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
561
562 @item @b{arm-jtag}
563 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
564
565 @item @b{chameleon}
566 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
567
568 @item @b{Triton}
569 @* Unknown.
570
571 @item @b{Lattice}
572 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
573 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
574
575 @item @b{flashlink}
576 @* From STMicroelectronics;
577 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
578
579 @end itemize
580
581 @section Other...
582 @itemize @bullet
583
584 @item @b{ep93xx}
585 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
586
587 @item @b{at91rm9200}
588 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
589
590 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
591 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
592
593 @item @b{imx_gpio}
594 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
595
596 @item @b{am335xgpio}
597 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @item @b{vdebug}
604 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
605 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
606 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
607 JTAG and DAP-level transports.
608
609 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
610 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
611 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
612 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
613 emulation model of target hardware.
614
615 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
616 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
617
618 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
619 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
620
621 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
622 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
623 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
624
625 @item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
626 @* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
627
628 @end itemize
629
630 @node About Jim-Tcl
631 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
632 @cindex Jim-Tcl
633 @cindex tcl
634
635 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
636 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
637 command interpreter.
638
639 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
640 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
641 much of anything about Tcl.
642 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
643
644 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
645 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
646 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
647 OpenOCD mailing list.
648
649 @itemize @bullet
650 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
651 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
652 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
653 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
654 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
655 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
656
657 @item @b{Missing Features}
658 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
659 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
660 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
661 enabled in OpenOCD.
662
663 @item @b{Scripts}
664 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
665 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
666 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
667
668 @item @b{Commands}
669 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
670 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
671 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
672 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
673
674 @item @b{Historical Note}
675 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
676 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
677 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
678 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
679
680 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
681 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
682 @end itemize
683
684 @node Running
685 @chapter Running
686 @cindex command line options
687 @cindex logfile
688 @cindex directory search
689
690 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
691 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
692 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
693 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
694 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
695 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
696 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
697
698 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
699 tell it how each debug session should work.
700 The @option{--help} option shows:
701 @verbatim
702 bash$ openocd --help
703
704 --help | -h display this help
705 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
706 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
707 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
708 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
709 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
710 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
711 --command | -c run <command>
712 @end verbatim
713
714 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
715 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
716 To specify one or more different
717 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
718
719 @example
720 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
721 @end example
722
723 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
724 @enumerate
725 @item the current directory,
726 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
727 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
728 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
729 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
730 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
731 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
732 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
733 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
734 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
735 @end enumerate
736 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
737
738 @quotation Note
739 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
740 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
741 @end quotation
742
743 @section Simple setup, no customization
744
745 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
746 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
747 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
748 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
749 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
750
751 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
752 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
753 the server with some variation of one of the following:
754
755 @example
756 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
757 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
758 @end example
759
760 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
761 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
762 If all goes well you'll see output something like
763
764 @example
765 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
766 For bug reports, read
767 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
768 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
769 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
770 @end example
771
772 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
773 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
774 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
775
776 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
777
778 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
779 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
780 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
781 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
782 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
783 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
784 ensure that this always succeeds.
785 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
786 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
787 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
788 and then shut down without acting as a server.
789
790 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
791 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
792 those channels.
793
794 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
795 the @option{-d} option.
796
797 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
798 @option{-c} command line switch.
799
800 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
801 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
802 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
803 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
804 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
805 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
806 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
807
808 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
809 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
810
811 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
812 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
813 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
814 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
815
816 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
817 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
818
819 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
820 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
821 and start the OpenOCD server.
822 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
823 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
824 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
825 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
826
827 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
828
829 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
830 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
831 and a USB cable on the other.
832 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
833 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
834
835 @enumerate
836 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
837 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
838 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
839 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
840 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
841 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
842 debugging host.
843
844 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
845 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
846 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
847 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
848 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
849
850 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
851 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
852 with 1.2 Volt boards.
853
854 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
855 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
856 ways to connect the cable.
857 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
858 Be sure it's firmly connected.
859
860 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
861 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
862 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
863 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
864 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
865 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
866 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
867 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
868
869 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
870 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
871 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
872 but are tedious to set up.
873 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
874 adapter signals to the right board pins.
875
876 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
877 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
878 you are using to run OpenOCD.
879 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
880
881 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
882 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
883 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
884 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
885
886 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
887 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
888 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
889
890 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
891 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
892 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
893 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
894
895 @end enumerate
896
897 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
898 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
899 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
900
901 @section Project Directory
902
903 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
904
905 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
906 single directory for your work with a given board.
907 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
908 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
909 files accessed through semihosting,
910 and for code you upload to the target board.
911 It is also the natural place to write files,
912 such as log files and data you download from the board.
913
914 @section Configuration Basics
915
916 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
917 a variety of ways you can mix them.
918 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
919
920 @itemize
921 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
922 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
923 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
924 @end itemize
925
926 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
927 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
928 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
929
930 @example
931 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
932
933 # GDB can also flash my flash!
934 gdb_memory_map enable
935 gdb_flash_program enable
936
937 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
938 @end example
939
940 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
941
942 @example
943 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
944 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
945 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
946 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
947 @end example
948
949 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
950 each supporting a different development task.
951 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
952 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
953
954 @quotation Important
955 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
956 problems with how it treats variables.
957 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
958 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
959 that can be tested in a later script.
960 @end quotation
961
962 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
963 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
964 to simplify your work.
965
966 @section User Config Files
967 @cindex config file, user
968 @cindex user config file
969 @cindex config file, overview
970
971 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
972 in one place.
973 One of the following will match your situation best:
974
975 @itemize
976 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
977 provided by someone else.
978 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
979 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
980 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
981 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
982 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
983 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
984
985 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
986 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
987
988 @enumerate
989 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
990 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
991 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
992 @end enumerate
993
994 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
995 The first is an interface config file.
996 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
997 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
998 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
999 meet your deadline:
1000
1001 @example
1002 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1003 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1004 @end example
1005
1006 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1007 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1008 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1009 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1010
1011 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1012 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1013 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1014 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1015 target and board
1016 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1017 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1018
1019 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1020 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1021 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1022 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1023
1024 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1025 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1026 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1027 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1028 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1029
1030 @quotation Note
1031 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1032 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1033 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1034 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1035 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1036 @end quotation
1037
1038 @item
1039 You may need to write some C code.
1040 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1041 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1042 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1043 a new chip architecture.
1044 @end itemize
1045
1046 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1047 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1048 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1049
1050 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1051 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1052 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1053 @itemize
1054
1055 @item
1056 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1057 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1058 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1059 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1060
1061 @item
1062 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1063 @cindex vector_catch
1064 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1065 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1066 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1067 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1068 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1069 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1070
1071 @item
1072 You might need to override some defaults.
1073 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1074 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1075
1076 @item
1077 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1078 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1079 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1080 @end itemize
1081
1082 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1083
1084 A few project-specific utility
1085 routines may well speed up your work.
1086 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1087
1088 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1089 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1090 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1091 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1092 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1093 may help:
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1098 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1099 # Leave the CPU halted.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1103 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1104
1105 # Start running.
1106 resume 0x20000000
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1111 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1112 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1113 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1114 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1115
1116 @example
1117 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1118 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1119 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1120 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1121 reset init
1122
1123 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1124 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1125 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1126 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1127 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1128 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1129 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1130
1131 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1132 reset run
1133 @}
1134 @end example
1135
1136 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1137 from NAND.
1138 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1139 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1140 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1141
1142 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1143 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1144
1145 @section Target Software Changes
1146
1147 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1148 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1149 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1150 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1151 handling issues like:
1152
1153 @itemize @bullet
1154
1155 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1156 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1157 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1158 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1159 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1160 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1161 your debug sessions.
1162
1163 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1164 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1165 That might however be your only option.
1166
1167 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1168 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1169 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1170 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1171 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1172 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1173 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1174 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1175 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1176 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1177 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1178 instead of the whole thing.
1179 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1180 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1181
1182 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1183 @cindex ARM semihosting
1184 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1185 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1186 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1187 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1188 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1189 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1190 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1191 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1192 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1193 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1194 NAND or SPI flash.
1195
1196 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1197 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1198 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1199 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1200 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1201
1202 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1203 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1204 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1205 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1206 registers which can be used to change various features including
1207 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1208 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1209 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1210 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1211 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1212
1213 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1214 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1215 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1216 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1217 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1218
1219 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1220 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1221 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1222 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1223 early code execution can be debugged
1224 or firmware can be replaced.
1225
1226 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1227 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1228 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1229 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1230 operations like writing to memory.)
1231
1232 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1233 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1234 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1235 various kinds of message.
1236 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1237
1238 @end itemize
1239
1240 @section Target Hardware Setup
1241
1242 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1243 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1244 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1245 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1246 working with.}
1247
1248 Common issues include:
1249
1250 @itemize @bullet
1251
1252 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1253 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1254 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1255 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1256 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1257 or one from a daughtercard).
1258 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1259 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1260
1261 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1262 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1263 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1264 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1265 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1266 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1267
1268 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1269 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1270 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1271 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1272 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1273
1274
1275 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1276 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1277 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1278 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1279 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1280 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1281 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1282
1283 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1284 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1285 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1286 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1287 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1288
1289 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1290 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1291 used to start booting.
1292
1293 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1294 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1295 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1296 multiple audio codec chips).
1297 This interacts with software
1298 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1299 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1300 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1301 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1302 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1303 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1304 audio or video codecs are used.
1305
1306 @end itemize
1307
1308 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1309 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1310 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1311 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1312 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1313 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1314 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1315 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1316 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1317 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1318
1319
1320 @node Config File Guidelines
1321 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1322
1323 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1324 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1325 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1326 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1327
1328 You should find the following directories under
1329 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1330 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1331 @itemize @bullet
1332 @item @file{interface} ...
1333 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1334 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1335 @item @file{board} ...
1336 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1337 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1338
1339 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1340 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1341 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1342 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1343 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1344 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1345 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1346 a CPU and an FPGA.
1347 @item @file{target} ...
1348 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1349 on a chip
1350 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1351 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1352 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1353 the target config file defines all of them.
1354 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1355 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1356 @end itemize
1357
1358 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1359 file may override features in any of the above files by
1360 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1361 commands specific to their situation.
1362
1363 @section Interface Config Files
1364
1365 The user config file
1366 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1367
1368 @example
1369 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1370 @end example
1371
1372 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1373 in use today with OpenOCD.
1374 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1375 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1376
1377 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1378 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1379 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1380 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1381 and need to provide a driver for it.
1382
1383 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1384 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1385 @end deffn
1386
1387 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1388 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1389 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1390 to use @command{find}, instead.
1391 @end deffn
1392
1393 @section Board Config Files
1394 @cindex config file, board
1395 @cindex board config file
1396
1397 The user config file
1398 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1399
1400 @example
1401 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1402 @end example
1403
1404 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1405 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1406 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1407
1408 @enumerate
1409 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1410 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1411 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1412 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1413 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1414 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1415 @end enumerate
1416
1417 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1418 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1419 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1420 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1421
1422 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1423 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1424 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1425 configuration works.
1426
1427 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1428
1429 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1430 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1431 convention on how to use certain variables.
1432
1433 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1434 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1435 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1436 used at will within a target configuration file.
1437
1438 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1439 for a board with three chips:
1440
1441 @example
1442 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1443 set CHIPNAME network
1444 set ENDIAN big
1445 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1446 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1447 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1448 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1449
1450 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1451 set CHIPNAME video
1452 set ENDIAN little
1453 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1454 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1455 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1456 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1457
1458 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1459 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1460 unset ENDIAN
1461 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1462 @end example
1463
1464 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1465 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1466 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1467 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1468 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1469 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1470 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1471 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1472
1473 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1474 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1475 naming collisions.
1476
1477 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1478 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1479 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1480 up other clocks and peripherals.
1481
1482 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1483 @cindex variable names
1484
1485 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1486 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1487 one such chip (as shown above).
1488 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1489 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1490 to promote consistency and
1491 so that board files can override target defaults.
1492
1493 Inputs to target config files include:
1494
1495 @itemize @bullet
1496 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1497 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1498 tap identifier dotted names.
1499 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1500 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1501 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1502 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1503 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1504 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1505 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1506 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1507 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1508 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 Outputs from target config files include:
1512
1513 @itemize @bullet
1514 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1515 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1516 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1517 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1518 specific to that board and that target.
1519 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1520 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1521 @end itemize
1522
1523 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1524 @cindex event, reset-init
1525 @cindex reset-init handler
1526
1527 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1528 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1529 fully set up yet.
1530 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1531 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1532 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1533 handler is one of the most important.
1534
1535 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1536 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1537 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1538 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1539 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1540
1541 @quotation Note
1542 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1543 are included here.
1544 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1545 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1546 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1547 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1548 @end quotation
1549
1550 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1551 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1552 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1553 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1554 those as parameters.
1555 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1556 and disabling the watchdog.
1557 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1558 the next developer doing such work.
1559 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1560
1561 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1562 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1563 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1564 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1565
1566 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1567
1568 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1569 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1570 a low JTAG clock rate.
1571 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1572 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1573 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1574 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1575 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1576 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1577 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1578
1579 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1580 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1581 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1582 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1583 which might be less than that.
1584
1585 @quotation Warning
1586 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1587 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1588 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1589 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1590 @end quotation
1591
1592 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1593 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1594 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1595 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1596 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1597 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1598
1599 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1600 @subsection The init_board procedure
1601 @cindex init_board procedure
1602
1603 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1604 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1605 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1606 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1607 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1608 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1609 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1610 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1611 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1612 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1613 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1614 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1615
1616 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1617 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1618
1619 @example
1620 ### board_file.cfg ###
1621
1622 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1623 source [find target/target.cfg]
1624
1625 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1626 # enables fast on-board clock source
1627 # configures the chip to use it
1628 @}
1629
1630 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1631 proc init_board @{@} @{
1632 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1633
1634 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1635 adapter speed 100
1636 @}
1637
1638 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1639 enable_fast_clock
1640 adapter speed 10000
1641 @}
1642 @}
1643 @end example
1644
1645 @section Target Config Files
1646 @cindex config file, target
1647 @cindex target config file
1648
1649 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1650 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1651 more target config files like this:
1652
1653 @example
1654 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1655 @end example
1656
1657 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1658 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1659 In summary the target files should contain
1660
1661 @enumerate
1662 @item Set defaults
1663 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1664 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1665 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1666 @item On-Chip flash
1667 @end enumerate
1668
1669 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1670 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1671 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1672
1673 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1674 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1675 can talk to the chip.
1676 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1677 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1678 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1679 and other processing engines.
1680
1681 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1682
1683 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1684 letting board config files express environment-specific
1685 differences in how things should be set up.
1686
1687 @example
1688 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1689 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1690 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1691 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1692 @} else @{
1693 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1694 @}
1695
1696 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1697 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1698 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1699 @} else @{
1700 set _ENDIAN little
1701 @}
1702
1703 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1704 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1705 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1706 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1707 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1708 @} else @{
1709 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1710 @}
1711 @end example
1712 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1713
1714 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1715 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1716 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1717
1718 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1719 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1720 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1721
1722 @example
1723 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1724 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1725 @end example
1726
1727 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1728 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1729 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1730 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1731 for taps.
1732
1733 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1734 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1735 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1736 looks (in part) like this:
1737
1738 @example
1739 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1740 @end example
1741
1742 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1743 to source such a config file twice, with different
1744 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1745 it adds a different TAP each time.
1746
1747 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1748 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1749 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1750 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1751
1752 @example
1753 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1754 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1755 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1756 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1757 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1758 @end example
1759
1760 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1761 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1762
1763 @itemize
1764 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1765 plus a JRC to enable them
1766 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1767 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1768 is not currently used)
1769 @end itemize
1770
1771 @subsection Add CPU targets
1772
1773 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1774 GDB and other commands can use it.
1775 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1776 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1777 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1778 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1779
1780 @example
1781 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1782 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1783 @end example
1784
1785 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1786 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1787 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1788 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1789 a work area if you can.
1790 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1791
1792 @example
1793 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1794 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1795 @end example
1796
1797 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1798 @cindex SMP
1799 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1800
1801 @example
1802 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1803 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1804 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1805 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1806 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1807 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1808 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1809 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1810 @end example
1811 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1812 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1815 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1816 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1817 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1818 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1819 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1820 @end itemize
1821
1822 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1823 command have been implemented.
1824 @itemize @bullet
1825 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1826 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1827 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1828 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1829 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1830 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1831 following example.
1832 @end itemize
1833
1834 @example
1835 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1837 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1839 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1840 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1841 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1842 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1843 > resume
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1847 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1848 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1849 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1850 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1851 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1852 @end example
1853
1854
1855 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1856
1857 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1858 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1859 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1860
1861 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1862 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1863 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1864 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1865 both signals.
1866
1867 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1868 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1869 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1870 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1871 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1872 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1873 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1874 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1875 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1876 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1877 not available.)
1878
1879 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1880 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1881 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1882 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1883 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1884 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1885 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1886 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1887
1888 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1889 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1890 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1891 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1892 slower clock than they will use later.
1893 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1894 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1895 than they will use later.
1896 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1897
1898 @quotation Important
1899 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1900 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1901 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1902 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1903 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1904 @end quotation
1905
1906 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1907 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1908 @cindex init_targets procedure
1909
1910 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1911 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1912 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1913 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1914 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1915 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1916 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1917 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1918 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1919
1920 @example
1921 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1924 # basic initialization procedure ...
1925 @}
1926
1927 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1928 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1929 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1930 @}
1931
1932 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1933
1934 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1935
1936 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1937 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1938 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1939 @}
1940 @end example
1941
1942 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1943 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1944
1945 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1946
1947 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1948 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1949
1950 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1951 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1952
1953 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1954 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1955 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1956 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1957 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1958 events already assigned.
1959
1960 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1961
1962 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1963 special high speed download features - enable it.
1964
1965 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1966
1967 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1968 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1969 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1970 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1971 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1972 If you are using an external trace port,
1973 configure it in your board config file.
1974 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1975 configure it in your target config file.
1976
1977 @example
1978 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1979 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1980 @end example
1981
1982 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1983
1984 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1985
1986 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1987 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1988 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1989 the TARGET (chip) file.
1990
1991 Examples:
1992 @itemize @bullet
1993 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1994 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1995 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1996 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1997 @end itemize
1998
1999 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
2000 @section Translating Configuration Files
2001 @cindex translation
2002 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2003 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2004 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2005 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2006 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2007 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2008
2009 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2010 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2011 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2012 convert other scripts later on.
2013
2014 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2015 replace job:
2016
2017 @example
2018 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2019 #
2020 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2021 #
2022 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2023 #
2024 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2025
2026 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2027 global TARGETNAME
2028
2029 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2030
2031 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2032 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2033 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2034 @}
2035 @end example
2036
2037
2038
2039 @node Server Configuration
2040 @chapter Server Configuration
2041 @cindex initialization
2042 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2043 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2044 supported.
2045
2046 @anchor{configurationstage}
2047 @section Configuration Stage
2048 @cindex configuration stage
2049 @cindex config command
2050
2051 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2052 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2053 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2054 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2055 inside startup scripts.
2056
2057 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2058 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2059 which may be issued interactively.
2060 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2061 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2062
2063 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2064 flash banks,
2065 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2066 and other basic setup.
2067 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2068 may access or activate TAPs.
2069 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2070 longer be issued.
2071
2072 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2073 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2074 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2075 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2076 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2077
2078 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2079 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2080 the command can be executed in either
2081 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2082 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2086 @section Entering the Run Stage
2087
2088 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2089 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2090 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2091 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2092 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2093 You should see no errors at this point.
2094 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2095 commands you used to configure the server.
2096 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2097 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2098 on the scan chain.
2099
2100 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2101 become available.
2102 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2103 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2104 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2105 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2106 entry to the run stage.
2107
2108 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2109 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2110 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2111 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2112 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2113 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2114 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2115
2116 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2117 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2118 configuration files and/or command line options.
2119
2120 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2121 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2122 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2123 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2124 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2125
2126 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2127 corresponding subsystems:
2128 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2129 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2130 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2131 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2132 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2133 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2134 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2138 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2139 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2140 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2141 @example
2142 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2143 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2144 @end example
2145 @end deffn
2146
2147 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2148 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2149 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2150 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2151 the run stage.
2152 @end deffn
2153
2154 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2155 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2156 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2157
2158 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2159 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2160 scan chain.
2161 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2162 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2163
2164 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2165 they return.
2166 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2167 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{tcpipports}
2171 @section TCP/IP Ports
2172 @cindex TCP port
2173 @cindex server
2174 @cindex port
2175 @cindex security
2176 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2177 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2178 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2179
2180 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2181 access using one or more of these ports.
2182 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2183 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2184 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2185
2186 You can request the operating system to select one of the available
2187 ports for the server by specifying the relevant port number as "0".
2188
2189 @anchor{gdb_port}
2190 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2191 @cindex GDB server
2192 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2193 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2194 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2195 the normal use cases.
2196
2197 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2198 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2199 disables the gdb server.
2200
2201 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2202 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2203
2204 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2205 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2206 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2207
2208 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2209 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2210 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2211 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2212 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2213 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2214 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2215 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2216 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2217
2218 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2219 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2220 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2224 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2225 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2226 output from the Tcl engine.
2227 Intended as a machine interface.
2228 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2229 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2230 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2234 Specify or query the
2235 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2236 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2237 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2238 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2239 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2243 @section GDB Configuration
2244 @cindex GDB
2245 @cindex GDB configuration
2246 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2247 The ones listed here are static and global.
2248 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2249 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2250
2251 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2252 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2253 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2254 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2255 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2256 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2257 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2258 @end deffn
2259
2260 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2261 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2262 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2263 vFlash packet is received.
2264 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2265 @end deffn
2266
2267 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2268 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2269 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2270 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2271 for flash programming to work.
2272 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2273 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2274 @end deffn
2275
2276 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2277 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2278 by GDB memory read packets.
2279 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2280 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2281 @end deffn
2282
2283 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2284 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2285 packets report errors or not.
2286 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2287 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2288 @end deffn
2289
2290 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2291 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2292 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2293 @end deffn
2294
2295 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2296 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2297
2298 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2299 @end deffn
2300
2301 @anchor{eventpolling}
2302 @section Event Polling
2303
2304 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2305 where significant events can happen at any time.
2306 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2307 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2308 or to GDB.
2309
2310 Examples of such events include:
2311
2312 @itemize
2313 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2314 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2315 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2316 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2317 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2318 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2319 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2320 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2321 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2322 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2323 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2324 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2325 @end itemize
2326
2327 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2328 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2329 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2330 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2331 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2332
2333 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2334 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2335 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2336 to the various active targets.
2337 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2338 which is normally done in the background.
2339
2340 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2341 Poll the current target for its current state.
2342 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2343 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2344 specific information about the current state is printed.
2345 An optional parameter
2346 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2347
2348 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2349 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2350 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2351 @example
2352 > poll
2353 background polling: on
2354 target state: halted
2355 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2356 current mode: Supervisor
2357 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2358 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2359 >
2360 @end example
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2364 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2365 @cindex config file, interface
2366 @cindex interface config file
2367
2368 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2369 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2370 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2371
2372 @quotation Note
2373 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2374 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2375 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2376 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2377 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2378 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2379 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2380 @end quotation
2381
2382 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2383 through commands in an interface configuration
2384 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2385 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2386
2387 @example
2388 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2389 @end example
2390
2391 These commands tell
2392 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2393 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2394
2395 @example
2396 # jlink interface
2397 adapter driver jlink
2398 @end example
2399
2400 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2401
2402
2403 @section Adapter Configuration
2404
2405 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2406 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2407 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2408
2409 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2410 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2411 target.
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2415 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2416 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2417 @end deffn
2418 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2419 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2420 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2421 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2422 the hardware can support.
2423 @end deffn
2424
2425 @anchor{adapter gpio}
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
2427 @option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
2428 @option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
2429 @option{led} @
2430 [ @
2431 gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
2432 @option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
2433 @option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
2434 @option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
2435 @option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
2436 ] ]}
2437
2438 Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
2439 defined:
2440
2441 @itemize @minus
2442 @item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
2443 JTAG transport signals
2444 @item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
2445 @item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
2446 @item @option{srst}: system reset signal
2447 @item @option{led}: optional activity led
2448
2449 @end itemize
2450
2451 Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
2452 number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
2453 active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
2454 open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
2455 modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
2456 instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
2457 the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
2458 "active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
2459 Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
2460 is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
2461 the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
2462 to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
2463 override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
2464 -active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
2465 equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
2466 -active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
2467 signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
2468 set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
2469 set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
2470 swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
2471 all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
2472 configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
2473 some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
2474 the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
2475 @end deffn
2476
2477 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2478 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2479 @end deffn
2480
2481 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2482 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2483 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2484 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2485 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2486 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2487
2488 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2489 @end deffn
2490
2491 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2492 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2493 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2494 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2495 arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, esp_usb_jtag, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2496 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2497 @end deffn
2498
2499 @section Interface Drivers
2500
2501 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2502 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2503 available at run time.
2504
2505 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2506 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2507 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2508 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2511 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2512 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2516 Displays status of RTCK option.
2517 Optionally sets that option first.
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {angie}
2522 This is the NanoXplore's ANGIE USB-JTAG Adapter.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2526 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2527 This has one driver-specific command:
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2530 Logs some status
2531 @end deffn
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2535 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2536 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2537 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2538 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2539 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2543 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2544 or v2 (USB bulk).
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2547 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2548 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2549 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2550 @example
2551 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2552 @end example
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2556 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2557
2558 @itemize @minus
2559 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2560 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2561 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2562 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2563 @end itemize
2564 @end deffn
2565
2566 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2567 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2568 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2569 interface string or for user class interface.
2570 @end deffn
2571
2572 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2573 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2577 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2578 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2579
2580 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2581 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2582 are logged.
2583 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2584 @end deffn
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2588 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2592 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2596 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2597 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2598
2599 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2600 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2601
2602 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2603 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2604
2605 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2606 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2607 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2608 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2609 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2610 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2611
2612 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2613 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2614 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2615 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2616 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2617
2618 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2619 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2620 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2621 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2622
2623 @itemize @minus
2624 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2625 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2626 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2627 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2628 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2629 switching data and direction as necessary
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2637 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2638 @example
2639 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2640 @end example
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2644 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2645 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2646 during device selection.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2650 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2651 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2655 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2656 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2657 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2658 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2659 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2660 and initially asserted reset signals.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2664 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2665 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2666 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2667 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2668 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2669 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2670 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2671 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2672 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2673 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2674
2675 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2676 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2677 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2678 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2679 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2680 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2681
2682 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2683 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2684 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2685 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2686 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2687 are always driven by the FTDI.
2688
2689 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2690 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2691 @var{name}.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2695 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2696 @itemize @minus
2697 @item @option{0}, drive low
2698 @item @option{1}, drive high
2699 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2700 @end itemize
2701 @end deffn
2702
2703 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2704 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2708 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2709
2710 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2711 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2712 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2713 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2714 @itemize @minus
2715 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2716 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2717 @end itemize
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2721 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2722
2723 @end deffn
2724
2725 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2726 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2727 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2728 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2729
2730 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2731 @itemize @minus
2732 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2733 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2734 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2735 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2736 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2737 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2738 @end itemize
2739
2740 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2741 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2742 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2743 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2744 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2745 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2746 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2747 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2748
2749 FT232R
2750 @itemize @minus
2751 @item bit 7 - RI
2752 @item bit 6 - DCD
2753 @item bit 5 - DSR
2754 @item bit 4 - DTR
2755 @item bit 3 - CTS
2756 @item bit 2 - RTS
2757 @item bit 1 - RXD
2758 @item bit 0 - TXD
2759 @end itemize
2760
2761 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2762 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2765 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2766 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2770 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2771 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2775 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2779 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2783 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2787 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2788 @end deffn
2789
2790 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2791 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2795 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2799 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2800 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2801 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2802 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2803 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2804 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2805 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2806 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2807 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2808 @end deffn
2809
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2813 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2814 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2815 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2816
2817 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2818 processors which are being simulated.
2819
2820 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2821 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2822 sockets instead of TCP.
2823 @end deffn
2824
2825 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2826 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2827 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2828 @end deffn
2829
2830 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2831 something like:
2832
2833 @example
2834 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2835 remote_bitbang port 3335
2836 remote_bitbang host foobar
2837 @end example
2838
2839 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2840 named mysocket:
2841
2842 @example
2843 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2844 remote_bitbang port 0
2845 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2846 @end example
2847 @end deffn
2848
2849 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2850 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2851 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2852 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2853
2854 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2855 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2856 default values are used.
2857 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2858 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2859 @example
2860 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2861 @end example
2862 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2863 @example
2864 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2865 @end example
2866 @end deffn
2867
2868 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2869 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2870 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2871 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2872 target board.
2873
2874 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2875 @example
2876 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2877 reset_config srst_only
2878 @end example
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2882 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2883 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2884 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2888 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2889 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2895 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2896 This has one driver-specific command:
2897
2898 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2899 Display either the address of the I/O port
2900 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2901 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2902 This is a write-once setting.
2903 @end deffn
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2907 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2908 transports.
2909
2910 @quotation Compatibility Note
2911 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2912 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2913 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2914 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2915 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2916 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2917 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2918 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2919 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2920 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2921 @end quotation
2922
2923 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2924 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2925 states.
2926 @end deffn
2927 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2928 Display free device internal memory.
2929 @end deffn
2930 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2931 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2932 command version.
2933 @end deffn
2934 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2935 Display the device configuration.
2936 @end deffn
2937 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2938 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2939 power state.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2942 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2943 @end deffn
2944 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2945 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2946 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2947 IP configuration.
2948 @end deffn
2949 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2950 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2951 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2952 @end deffn
2953 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2954 Reset the current configuration.
2955 @end deffn
2956 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2957 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2958 @end deffn
2959 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2960 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2961 pairs.
2962
2963 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2964 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2965 @example
2966 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2967 @end example
2968 @end deffn
2969 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2970 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2971 pairs.
2972
2973 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2974 @example
2975 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2976 77a90000
2977 @end example
2978 @end deffn
2979 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2980 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2981 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2982 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2983 the serial number instead, if possible.
2984
2985 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2986 @end deffn
2987 @end deffn
2988
2989 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2990 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2991 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2992 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2993 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2994 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2995 configuration script.
2996
2997 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2998 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2999 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
3000 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
3001 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
3002
3003 Known limitations:
3004 @itemize @bullet
3005 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
3006 and 2.7 MHz.
3007 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
3008 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
3009 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
3010 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
3011 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
3012 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
3013 communications with the target.
3014 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
3015 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
3016 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
3017 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
3018 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
3019 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
3020 @end itemize
3021
3022 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
3023 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
3024 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
3028 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
3029 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
3030 target as a side-effect.
3031 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
3035 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
3036 version, and target voltage.
3037 @end deffn
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
3041 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
3042 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
3043 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
3044 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
3045
3046 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
3047 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
3048 This is a write-once setting.
3049 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
3050
3051 @itemize @minus
3052 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
3053 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
3054 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
3055 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
3056 in configuration mode. This is only used to
3057 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
3058 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
3059 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
3060 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
3061 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
3062 some versions of
3063 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3064 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3065 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3066 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3067 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3068 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3069 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3070 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3071 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3072 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3073 @end itemize
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3077 Display either the address of the I/O port
3078 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3079 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3080 This is a write-once setting.
3081
3082 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3083 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3084 you may encounter a problem.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3088 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3089 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3090 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3091 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3092 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3093
3094 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3095 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3096 @quotation Tip
3097 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3098 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3099 @example
3100 > parport toggling_time 1000
3101 > adapter speed 500
3102 @end example
3103 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3104 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3105 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3106 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3107 large set of samples.
3108 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3109 @example
3110 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3111 @end example
3112 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3113 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3114
3115 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3116 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3117 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3118 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3119 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3120 be conservative.
3121 @end quotation
3122 @end deffn
3123
3124 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3125 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3126 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3130 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3131
3132 @example
3133 adapter driver parport
3134 parport port 0x278
3135 parport cable wiggler
3136 @end example
3137 @end deffn
3138
3139 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3140 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3144 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3145 @end deffn
3146
3147 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3148 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3149 @end deffn
3150
3151 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3152 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3153
3154 @quotation Note
3155 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3156 which are not currently documented here.
3157 @end quotation
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @anchor{hla_interface}
3161 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3162 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3163 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3164 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3165
3166 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3167 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3168 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3169 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3170 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3171 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3172
3173 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3174 Currently Not Supported.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3178 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3182 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3183 @end deffn
3184
3185 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3186 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3187 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3188
3189 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3190 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3191 ST-LINK server software module}.
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3195 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3196 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3197 @end deffn
3198 @end deffn
3199
3200 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3201 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3202 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3203 (from firmware V2J24), STLINK-V3 and STLINK-V3PWR, thanks to a new API that provides
3204 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3205
3206 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3207 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3208 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3209 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3210
3211 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3212 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3213
3214 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3215 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3216 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3217
3218 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3219 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3220 ST-LINK server software module}.
3221
3222 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3226 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3230 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3231 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3232
3233 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3234 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3235 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3236 the target's supply voltage.
3237 @example
3238 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3239 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3240 @end example
3241 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3242 @example
3243 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3244 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3245 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3246 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3247 3.24891518738
3248 @end example
3249 @end deffn
3250 @end deffn
3251
3252 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3253 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3254 @end deffn
3255
3256 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3257 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3261 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3262 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3263 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3264 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3265
3266 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3267 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3268 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3269 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3270 @end deffn
3271
3272 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3273 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3274 version).
3275 @end deffn
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3279 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3280 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3281 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3282 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3283
3284 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3285
3286 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3287 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3288
3289 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3290 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3291
3292 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3293
3294 @end deffn
3295 @end deffn
3296
3297 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3298 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3299 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3300
3301 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3302 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3303 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3304 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3305 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3306 configuration on exit.
3307
3308 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons. GPIO configuration is
3309 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3310
3311 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3312 @file{interface/raspberrypi-gpio-connector.cfg} for pinout.
3313
3314 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3315 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3316 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_mem_dev} @var{device}
3320 Set the device path for access to the memory mapped GPIO control registers.
3321 Uses @file{/dev/gpiomem} by default, this is also the preferred option with
3322 respect to system security.
3323 If overridden to @file{/dev/mem}:
3324 @itemize @minus
3325 @item OpenOCD needs @code{cap_sys_rawio} or run as root to open @file{/dev/mem}.
3326 Please be aware of security issues imposed by running OpenOCD with
3327 elevated user rights and by @file{/dev/mem} itself.
3328 @item correct @command{peripheral_base} must be configured.
3329 @item GPIO 0-27 pads are set to the limited slew rate
3330 and drive strength is reduced to 4 mA (2 mA on RPi 4).
3331 @end itemize
3332
3333 @end deffn
3334
3335 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3336 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs.
3337 Ignored if @file{/dev/gpiomem} is used. For the RPi1, use
3338 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3339 list can be found in the
3340 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3341 @end deffn
3342
3343 @end deffn
3344
3345 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3346 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3347 of the one which is most popular.
3348
3349 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3350
3351 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3352 pinout.
3353
3354 @end deffn
3355
3356
3357 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3358 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3359 on the two expansion headers.
3360
3361 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3362 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3363 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3364 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3365
3366 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
3367 command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3368
3369 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3370 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3371 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3372 @end deffn
3373
3374 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3375
3376 @end deffn
3377
3378
3379 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3380 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
3381 version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
3382 bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
3383 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
3384 driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
3385 command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
3386
3387 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390
3391 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3392 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3393 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3394
3395 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398
3399 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3400 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3401 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3402
3403 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3404 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3405 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3406
3407 @itemize @minus
3408 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3409 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3410 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3411 @end itemize
3412 @end deffn
3413
3414 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3415 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3416 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3417 @end deffn
3418 @end deffn
3419
3420
3421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3422 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3423
3424 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3425 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3426 @end deffn
3427
3428 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3429 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3430 0 for no batching
3431 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3432 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3433 @end deffn
3434
3435 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3436 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3437 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3438 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3439 timeout value.
3440 @end deffn
3441
3442 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3443 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3444 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3445 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3446 @end deffn
3447
3448 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3449 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3450 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3451 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3452 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3453 @end deffn
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3457 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3458 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3459 DPI server interface.
3460
3461 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3462 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3463 @end deffn
3464
3465 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3466 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3467 @end deffn
3468 @end deffn
3469
3470
3471 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3472
3473 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3474 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3475
3476 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3477 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3478
3479 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3480 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3481 @example
3482 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3483 @end example
3484 @end deffn
3485
3486 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3487 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3488 @example
3489 buspirate speed normal
3490 @end example
3491 @end deffn
3492
3493 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3494 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3495 @itemize @minus
3496 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3497 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3498 @end itemize
3499 For example:
3500 @example
3501 buspirate mode normal
3502 @end example
3503 @end deffn
3504
3505 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3506 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3507 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3508 For example:
3509 @example
3510 buspirate pullup 0
3511 @end example
3512 @end deffn
3513
3514 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3515 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3516 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3517 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3518 @example
3519 buspirate vreg 0
3520 @end example
3521 @end deffn
3522
3523 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3524 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3525 @end deffn
3526 @example
3527 buspirate led 1
3528 @end example
3529
3530 @end deffn
3531
3532 @deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
3533 Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
3534 These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
3535 Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
3536
3537 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
3538 Returns the current state of the TDO line
3539 @end deffn
3540
3541 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
3542 Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
3543 @example
3544 espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
3545 @end example
3546 @end deffn
3547
3548 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
3549 Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
3550 @example
3551 espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
3552 @end example
3553 @end deffn
3554
3555 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
3556 Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
3557 @example
3558 espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
3559 @end example
3560 @end deffn
3561
3562 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
3563 Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
3564 @example
3565 espusbjtag chip_id 1
3566 @end example
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569 @end deffn
3570
3571 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dmem} Direct Memory access debug interface
3572
3573 The Texas Instruments K3 SoC family provides memory access to DAP
3574 and coresight control registers. This allows control over the
3575 microcontrollers directly from one of the processors on the SOC
3576 itself.
3577
3578 For maximum performance, the driver accesses the debug registers
3579 directly over the SoC memory map. The memory mapping requires read
3580 and write permission to kernel memory via "/dev/mem" and assumes that
3581 the system firewall configurations permit direct access to the debug
3582 memory space.
3583
3584 @verbatim
3585 +-----------+
3586 | OpenOCD | SoC mem map (/dev/mem)
3587 | on +--------------+
3588 | Cortex-A53| |
3589 +-----------+ |
3590 |
3591 +-----------+ +-----v-----+
3592 |Cortex-M4F <--------+ |
3593 +-----------+ | |
3594 | DebugSS |
3595 +-----------+ | |
3596 |Cortex-M4F <--------+ |
3597 +-----------+ +-----------+
3598 @end verbatim
3599
3600 NOTE: Firewalls are configurable in K3 SoC and depending on various types of
3601 device configuration, this function may be blocked out. Typical behavior
3602 observed in such cases is a firewall exception report on the security
3603 controller and armv8 processor reporting a system error.
3604
3605 See @file{tcl/interface/ti_k3_am625-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration
3606 file.
3607
3608 @deffn {Command} {dmem info}
3609 Print the DAPBUS dmem configuration.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem device} device_path
3613 Set the DAPBUS memory access device (default: /dev/mem).
3614 @end deffn
3615
3616 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem base_address} base_address
3617 Set the DAPBUS base address which is used to access CoreSight
3618 compliant Access Ports (APs) directly.
3619 @end deffn
3620
3621 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem ap_address_offset} offset_address
3622 Set the address offset between Access Ports (APs).
3623 @end deffn
3624
3625 @deffn {Config Command} {dmem max_aps} n
3626 Set the maximum number of valid access ports on the SoC.
3627 @end deffn
3628
3629 @end deffn
3630
3631 @section Transport Configuration
3632 @cindex Transport
3633 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3634 and the debug adapter you are using,
3635 several transports may be available to
3636 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3637 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3638 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3639 version of OpenOCD.
3640 @end deffn
3641
3642 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3643 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3644
3645 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3646 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3647 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3648 adapter's driver).
3649
3650 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3651 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3652 supported by the debug adapter.
3653
3654 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3655 transport, if any.
3656 @end deffn
3657
3658 @subsection JTAG Transport
3659 @cindex JTAG
3660 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3661 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3662 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3663 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3664 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3665 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3666
3667 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3668 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3669 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3670 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3671 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3672
3673 @subsection SWD Transport
3674 @cindex SWD
3675 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3676 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3677 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3678 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3679 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3680 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3681 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3682
3683 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3684 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3685 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3686 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3687 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3688
3689 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3690 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3691 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3692 expected to change.
3693 @end deffn
3694
3695 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3696 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3697 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3698 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3699 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3700 DAPs are created.
3701
3702 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3703 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3704 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3705
3706 @subsection SPI Transport
3707 @cindex SPI
3708 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3709 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3710 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3711 solution for flash programming.
3712
3713 @anchor{swimtransport}
3714 @subsection SWIM Transport
3715 @cindex SWIM
3716 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3717 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3718 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3719 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3720
3721 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3722
3723 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3724
3725 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3726 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3727 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3728 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3729 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3730
3731 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3732 @section JTAG Speed
3733 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3734 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3735 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3736 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3737 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3738 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3739 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3740 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3741 power management software that may be active.
3742
3743 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3744 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3745 target event handler.
3746 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3747 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3748 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3749 sets up those clocks).
3750 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3751 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3752 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3753 in the target config file.
3754 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3755 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3756 config file instead.
3757 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3758 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3759 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3760
3761 @example
3762 jtag_rclk 3000
3763 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3764 @end example
3765
3766 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3767 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3768 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3769 may not be the fastest solution.
3770
3771 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3772 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3773 which support adaptive clocking.
3774
3775 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3776 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3777 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3778 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3779 than the speed specified.
3780
3781 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3782 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3783 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3784 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3785
3786 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3787 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3788 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3789 JTAG clocking after setup.
3790 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3791 If the interface device can not
3792 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3793 @end deffn
3794
3795 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3796 @cindex adaptive clocking
3797 @cindex RTCK
3798 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3799 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3800 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3801 @example
3802 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3803 jtag_rclk 3000
3804 @end example
3805 @end defun
3806
3807 @node Reset Configuration
3808 @chapter Reset Configuration
3809 @cindex Reset Configuration
3810
3811 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3812 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3813 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3814 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3815 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3816 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3817 Please see the various board files for examples.
3818
3819 @quotation Note
3820 To maintainers and integrators:
3821 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3822 Normally the board configuration file
3823 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3824 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3825
3826 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3827 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3828 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3829 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3830 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3831 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3832 @end quotation
3833
3834 @section Types of Reset
3835
3836 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3837 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3838 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3839
3840 @itemize @bullet
3841 @item
3842 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3843 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3844 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3845 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3846 @item
3847 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3848 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3849 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3850 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3851 @item
3852 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3853 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3854 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3855 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3856 @item
3857 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3858 several other types of reset.
3859 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3860 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3861 There may be individual module resets.
3862 @end itemize
3863
3864 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3865 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3866 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3867 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3868 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3869 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3870 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3871 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3872 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3873
3874 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3875 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3876
3877 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3878 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3879 common issues are:
3880
3881 @itemize @bullet
3882
3883 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3884 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3885 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3886 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3887 when either of those signals is not connected.
3888 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3889 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3890 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3891 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3892
3893 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3894 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3895 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3896 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3897
3898 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3899 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3900 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3901 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3902 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3903 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3904 hardware debouncing.
3905 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3906 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3907
3908 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3909 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3910 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3911 to use push/pull output drivers.
3912 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3913 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3914 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3915 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3916
3917 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3918 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3919 issues (not limited to errata).
3920 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3921 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3922 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3923 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3924 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3925 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3926 @end itemize
3927
3928 There can also be other issues.
3929 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3930 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3931 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3932 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3933 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3934 Agreement (NDA).
3935
3936 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3937 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3938 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3939
3940 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3941 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3942
3943 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3944
3945 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3946 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3947 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3948 allowing it to be deasserted.
3949 @end deffn
3950
3951 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3952 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3953 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3954 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3955 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3956 @end deffn
3957
3958 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3959 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3960 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3961 allowing it to be deasserted.
3962 @end deffn
3963
3964 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3965 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3966 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3967 @end deffn
3968
3969 @anchor{reset_config}
3970 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3971 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3972 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3973 configuration scripts.
3974
3975 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3976 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3977 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3978 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3979 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3980 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3981 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3982 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3983
3984 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3985 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3986 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3987 -- may be specified at a time.
3988 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3989 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3990 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3991 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3992 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3993
3994 @itemize
3995 @item
3996 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3997 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3998 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3999 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
4000 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
4001
4002 @quotation Tip
4003 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
4004 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
4005 @end quotation
4006
4007 @item
4008 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
4009 signal implementations.
4010 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
4011 indicating everything behaves normally.
4012 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
4013 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
4014 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
4015 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
4016 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
4017 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
4018 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
4019
4020 @item
4021 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4022 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
4023 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
4024 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
4025 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
4026 while SRST is asserted.
4027 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
4028 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
4029
4030 @item
4031 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4032 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
4033 is required to use this option.
4034 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
4035 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
4036 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
4037 be asserted before any target connection.
4038 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
4039 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
4040 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
4041 @end itemize
4042
4043 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
4044 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
4045 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
4046 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
4047 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
4048
4049 @itemize
4050 @item
4051 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
4052 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
4053 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
4054 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
4055
4056 @item
4057 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
4058 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
4059 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
4060 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4061 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4062 @end itemize
4063 @end deffn
4064
4065 @section Custom Reset Handling
4066 @cindex events
4067
4068 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4069 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4070 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4071 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4072 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4073 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4074
4075 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4076 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4077 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4078 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4079 want to reset everything at once.
4080
4081 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4082 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4083 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4084 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4085 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4086 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4087 needs special attention.
4088
4089 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4090 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4091 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4092 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4093 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4094 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4095 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4096 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4097 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4098
4099 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4100 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4101 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4102 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4103 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4104
4105 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4106 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4107 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4108 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4109 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4110 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4111 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4112 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4113 or potentially some other value.
4114
4115 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4116 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4117 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4118 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4119 (or their associated targets)
4120 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4121
4122 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4123 they return.
4124 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4125 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4126 @end deffn
4127
4128 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4129 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4130 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4131 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4132 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4133 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4134 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4135 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4136 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4137 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4138 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4139 @end deffn
4140
4141 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4142 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4143 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4144 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4145 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4146 @end deffn
4147
4148
4149 @node TAP Declaration
4150 @chapter TAP Declaration
4151 @cindex TAP declaration
4152 @cindex TAP configuration
4153
4154 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4155 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4156
4157 @itemize @bullet
4158 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4159 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4160 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4161 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4162 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4163 start running that code.
4164 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4165 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4166 and missing connections.
4167 @end itemize
4168
4169 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4170 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4171 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4172 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4173 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4174
4175 @section Scan Chains
4176 @cindex scan chain
4177
4178 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4179 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4180 They also need to be added to
4181 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4182 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4183 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4184 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4185 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4186 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4187 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4188 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4189
4190 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4191 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4192 command, presented in the next chapter.
4193 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4194 debugging targets.)
4195 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4196
4197 @verbatim
4198 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4199 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4200 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4201 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4202 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4203 @end verbatim
4204
4205 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4206 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4207 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4208 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4209 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4210 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4211 until they are told to do so.
4212
4213 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4214 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4215 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4216 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4217
4218 @example
4219 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4220 @end example
4221
4222 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4223 by a given chip.
4224 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4225 and so forth.
4226 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4227 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4228 both inside a single chip and between them.
4229 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4230
4231 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4232 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4233 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4234 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4235 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4236 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4237 includes commands something like this:
4238
4239 @example
4240 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4241 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4242 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4243 @end example
4244
4245 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4246 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4247 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4248
4249 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4250 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4251 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4252 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4253 @example
4254 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4255 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4256 @}
4257 @end example
4258 @end deffn
4259
4260 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4261 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4262 and their status.
4263 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4264 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4265 but systems with a JTAG router can
4266 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4267 @end deffn
4268
4269 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4270 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4271
4272 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4273 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4274
4275 @section TAP Names
4276 @cindex dotted name
4277
4278 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4279 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4280 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4281 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4282 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4283 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4284 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4285 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4286
4287 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4288 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4289 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4290
4291 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4292
4293 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4294 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4295 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4296
4297 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4298 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4299 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4300 overridable.
4301
4302 @cindex TAP naming convention
4303 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4304 and should follow this convention:
4305
4306 @itemize @bullet
4307 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4308 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4309 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4310 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4311 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4312 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4313 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4314 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4315 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4316 with a single TAP;
4317 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4318 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4319 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4320 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4321 @end itemize
4322
4323 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4324
4325 @itemize @bullet
4326 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4327 @*The length in bits of the
4328 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4329 @end itemize
4330
4331 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4332
4333 @itemize @bullet
4334 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4335 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4336 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4337 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4338 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4339 (the TAP is linked in).
4340 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4341 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4342 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4343 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4344 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4345 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4346 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4347 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4348 values that were found but not included in the list.
4349
4350 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4351 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4352 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4353 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4354 hardware to find these values.
4355 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4356 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4357 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4358 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4359 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4360 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4361 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4362 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4363 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4364 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4365 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4366 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4367 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4368 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4369 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4370 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4371 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4372 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4373 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4374 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4375 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4376 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4377 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4378 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4379 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4380 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4381 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4382 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4383 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4384 @end itemize
4385 @end deffn
4386
4387 @section Other TAP commands
4388
4389 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4390 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4391 @end deffn
4392
4393 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4394 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4395 At this writing this TAP attribute
4396 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4397 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4398 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4399 See the next section for information about the available events.
4400
4401 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4402 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4403 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4404 @end deffn
4405
4406 @section TAP Events
4407 @cindex events
4408 @cindex TAP events
4409
4410 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4411 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4412 The other applies to debugger targets,
4413 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4414
4415 The TAP events currently defined are:
4416
4417 @itemize @bullet
4418 @item @b{post-reset}
4419 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4420 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4421 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4422 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4423 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4424
4425 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4426 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4427 of any particular target.
4428 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4429 @item @b{setup}
4430 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4431 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4432 @item @b{tap-disable}
4433 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4434 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4435 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4436 @item @b{tap-enable}
4437 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4438 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4439 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4440 @end itemize
4441
4442 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4443 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4444 contents to be accurate), you might:
4445
4446 @example
4447 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4448 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4449 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4450 @}
4451 @end example
4452
4453
4454 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4455 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4456 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4457 @cindex jrc
4458
4459 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4460 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4461 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4462 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4463 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4464
4465 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4466 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4467 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4468 be visible.
4469 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4470 ignores, such as:
4471
4472 @itemize
4473 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4474 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4475 TAPs receive new instructions.
4476 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4477 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4478 @end itemize
4479
4480 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4481 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4482 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4483 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4484
4485 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4486 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4487
4488 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4489 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4490 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4491 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4492 should define TAP event handlers using
4493 code that looks something like this:
4494
4495 @example
4496 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4497 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4498 @}
4499 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4500 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4501 @}
4502 @end example
4503
4504 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4505
4506 @example
4507 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4508 @end example
4509
4510 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4511 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4512 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4513 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4514
4515 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4516 If necessary, disables the tap
4517 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4518 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4519 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4520 and "0" if it is disabled.
4521 @end deffn
4522
4523 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4524 If necessary, enables the tap
4525 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4526 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4527 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4528 and "0" if it is disabled.
4529 @end deffn
4530
4531 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4532 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4533 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4534 and "0" if it is disabled.
4535
4536 @quotation Note
4537 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4538 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4539 @end quotation
4540 @end deffn
4541
4542 @anchor{autoprobing}
4543 @section Autoprobing
4544 @cindex autoprobe
4545 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4546
4547 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4548 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4549 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4550 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4551
4552 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4553 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4554 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4555 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4556 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4557 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4558 right when they come out of reset).
4559
4560 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4561
4562 @example
4563 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4564 reset_config trst_and_srst
4565 jtag_rclk 8
4566 @end example
4567
4568 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4569 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4570
4571 @enumerate
4572 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4573 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4574 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4575 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4576 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4577 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4578 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4579 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4580 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4581 that is discovered.
4582 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4583 register, it will report it.
4584 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4585 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4586 @end enumerate
4587
4588 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4589 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4590 that's a bit more complex:
4591
4592 @example
4593 clock speed 8 kHz
4594 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4595 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4596 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4597 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4598 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4599 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4600 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4601 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4602 @end example
4603
4604 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4605 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4606 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4607 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4608 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4609 and so forth.
4610
4611 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4612 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4613 @cindex DAP declaration
4614
4615 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4616 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4617 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4618 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4619 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4620
4621 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4622
4623 @anchor{dap_create}
4624 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4625 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4626 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4627 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4628 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4629
4630 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4631
4632 @itemize @bullet
4633 @item @code{-adiv5}
4634 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4635 @item @code{-adiv6}
4636 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4637 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4638 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4639 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4640 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4641 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4642
4643 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4644 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4645 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4646 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4647 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4648 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4649
4650 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4651 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4652 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4653 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4654 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4655 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4656 @end itemize
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4660 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4661 for TCL scripting.
4662 @end deffn
4663
4664 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4665 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4666 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4667 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4668 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4669 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4670 @end deffn
4671
4672 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4673 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4674 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4675 initialization, too.
4676 @end deffn
4677
4678 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4679
4680 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4681 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4682 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4683 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4684 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4685 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4689 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4690 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4691 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4692 @end deffn
4693
4694 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4695 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4696 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4697 or set a new value @var{value}.
4698 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4699 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4700 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4701 @end deffn
4702
4703 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4704 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4705 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4706 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4707 @end deffn
4708
4709 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4710 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4711 value @var{value}.
4712
4713 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4714 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4715 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4716
4717 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4718 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4719 @end deffn
4720
4721 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4722 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4723 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4724 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4725 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4726 @end deffn
4727
4728 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4729 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4730 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4731 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4735 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4736
4737 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4738 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4739 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4740 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4741 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4742 for details.
4743
4744 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4745 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4746 the pattern:
4747 @example
4748 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4749 @end example
4750
4751 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4752 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4753 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4754 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4755 @example
4756 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4757 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4758 @end example
4759
4760 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4761 @example
4762 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4763 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4764 @end example
4765
4766 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4767 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4768
4769 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4770 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4771 example with a proper dap name:
4772 @example
4773 xxx.dap apcsw default
4774 @end example
4775 @end deffn
4776
4777 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4778 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4779 Disabled by default
4780 @end deffn
4781
4782 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4783 Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
4784 Disabled by default
4785 @end deffn
4786
4787 @node CPU Configuration
4788 @chapter CPU Configuration
4789 @cindex GDB target
4790
4791 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4792 You can also access these targets without GDB
4793 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4794 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4795 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4796 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4797
4798 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4799 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4800
4801 @section Target List
4802 @cindex target, current
4803 @cindex target, list
4804
4805 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4806 where each member has a name.
4807 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4808 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4809 (plural!) command.
4810 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4811 look like with more than one:
4812 @verbatim
4813 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4814 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4815 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4816 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4817 @end verbatim
4818
4819 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4820 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4821 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4822 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4823 space seen by that current target.
4824 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4825 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4826 are examples; and there are many more.
4827
4828 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4829
4830 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4831 Returns the name of the current target.
4832 @end deffn
4833
4834 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4835 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4836 @example
4837 foreach t [target names] @{
4838 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4839 @}
4840 @end example
4841 @end deffn
4842
4843 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4844 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4845
4846 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4847 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4848 command names are singular.}
4849
4850 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4851 targets in a user friendly form.
4852
4853 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4854 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4855 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4856 @end deffn
4857
4858 @section Target CPU Types
4859 @cindex target type
4860 @cindex CPU type
4861
4862 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4863 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4864 when calling @command{target create}.
4865 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4866 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4867 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4868 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4869 what core-specific commands may be available
4870 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4871 and more.
4872
4873 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4874 since there's a command to list them.
4875
4876 @anchor{targettypes}
4877 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4878 Lists all supported target types.
4879 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4880
4881 @itemize @bullet
4882 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4883 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4884 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4885 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4886 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4887 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4888 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4889 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4890 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4891 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4892 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4893 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4894 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4895 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4896 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4897 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4898 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4899 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4900 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4901 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4902 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4903 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4904 @item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4905 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4906 @item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4907 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4908 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4909 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4910 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4911 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4912 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4913 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4914 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4915 support for new CPUs.
4916 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4917 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4918 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4919 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4920 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4921 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4922 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4923 @itemize @minus
4924 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4925 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4926 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4927 @end itemize
4928 And two debug interfaces cores:
4929 @itemize @minus
4930 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4931 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4932 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4933 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4934 @end itemize
4935 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4936 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4937 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4938 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4939 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4940 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4941 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4942 @item @code{xtensa} -- this is a generic Cadence/Tensilica Xtensa core.
4943 @end itemize
4944 @end deffn
4945
4946 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4947 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4948 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4949 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4950 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4951 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4952 reflect design generations;
4953 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4954 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4955
4956 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4957 @section Target Configuration
4958
4959 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4960 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4961 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4962 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4963 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4964
4965 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4966 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4967 optional parts.
4968 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4969 command, created as part of target creation.
4970
4971 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4972 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4973 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4974 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4975 to be much more board-specific.
4976 The key steps you use might look something like this
4977
4978 @example
4979 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4980 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4981 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4982 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4983 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4984 @end example
4985
4986 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4987 on-chip SRAM.
4988 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4989 writes to target memory;
4990 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4991 GDB memory checksumming;
4992 and more.
4993
4994 @quotation Warning
4995 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4996 inaccessible when application code
4997 (such as an operating system)
4998 enables or disables the MMU.
4999 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
5000 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
5001 easy access to other addresses needed.
5002 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
5003 @end quotation
5004
5005 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
5006 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
5007 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
5008 controllers.
5009 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
5010 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
5011 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
5012
5013 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
5014 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
5015 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
5016 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
5017 purposes including additional configuration.
5018
5019 @itemize @bullet
5020 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
5021 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
5022 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
5023 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
5024
5025 This name is also used to create the target object command,
5026 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
5027 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
5028 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
5029 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
5030 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
5031 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
5032
5033 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
5034 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
5035 @end itemize
5036 @end deffn
5037
5038 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
5039 The options accepted by this command may also be
5040 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
5041 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
5042 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
5043
5044 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
5045 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
5046 and changing its endianness.
5047
5048 @itemize @bullet
5049
5050 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
5051 used to access this target.
5052
5053 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
5054 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
5055 create and manage DAP instances.
5056
5057 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
5058 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
5059
5060 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
5061 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5062 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
5063 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
5064 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
5065 same event name assigns only one handler.
5066
5067 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
5068 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
5069
5070 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
5071 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
5072 @emph{it is not backed up.}
5073 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
5074 since performing a backup slows down operations.
5075 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5076 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5077
5078 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5079 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5080 or virtual address is being used.
5081
5082 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5083 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5084
5085 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5086 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5087 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5088 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5089 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5090
5091 @anchor{rtostype}
5092 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5093 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
5094 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5095 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5096 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}, @option{rtkernel}
5097 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5098
5099 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5100 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5101 access the target for debugging.
5102
5103 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5104 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5105 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5106 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5107 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5108
5109 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5110 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5111 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5112 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5113 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5114
5115 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5116 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5117 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5118 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5119 command @command{gdb_port}.
5120 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5121
5122 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5123 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5124 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5125 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5126 @end itemize
5127 @end deffn
5128
5129 @section Other $target_name Commands
5130 @cindex object command
5131
5132 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5133 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5134
5135 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5136 Once a button is created a button
5137 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5138 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5139 configure it like this:
5140
5141 @example
5142 # Create
5143 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5144 # Modify
5145 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5146 # Query
5147 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5148 # Report
5149 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5150 @end example
5151
5152 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5153 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5154
5155 @example
5156 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5157 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5158 @end example
5159
5160 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5161
5162 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5163 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5164 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5165 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5166 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5167 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5168 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5169 They are not otherwise documented here.
5170 @end deffn
5171
5172 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5173 Set register values of the target.
5174
5175 @itemize
5176 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5177 @end itemize
5178
5179 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5180 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5181
5182 @example
5183 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5184 @end example
5185 @end deffn
5186
5187 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5188 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5189 of register names and values.
5190 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5191 target, bypassing any caching.
5192
5193 @itemize
5194 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5195 @end itemize
5196
5197 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5198 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5199
5200 @example
5201 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5202 @end example
5203 @end deffn
5204
5205 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5206 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5207 script.
5208
5209 @itemize
5210 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5211 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5212 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5213 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5214 @end itemize
5215
5216 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5217 memory at address 0x20000000:
5218
5219 @example
5220 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5221 @end example
5222 @end deffn
5223
5224 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5225 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5226 script.
5227 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5228
5229 @itemize
5230 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5231 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5232 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5233 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5234 @end itemize
5235
5236 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5237 memory at address 0x20000000:
5238
5239 @example
5240 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5241 @end example
5242 @end deffn
5243
5244 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5245 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5246 @command{$target_name configure}
5247 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5248 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5249 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5250 There are a few special cases:
5251
5252 @itemize @bullet
5253 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5254 event named @var{event_name}.
5255 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5256 two parameters.
5257 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5258 This is a special case because this is set using
5259 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5260 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5261 @end itemize
5262
5263 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5264 all the targets you might use something like this:
5265
5266 @example
5267 foreach name [target names] @{
5268 set y [$name cget -endian]
5269 set z [$name cget -type]
5270 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5271 $x $name $y $z]
5272 @}
5273 @end example
5274 @end deffn
5275
5276 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5277 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5278 Displays the current target state:
5279 @code{debug-running},
5280 @code{halted},
5281 @code{reset},
5282 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5283 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5287 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5288 currently associated with this target.
5289 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5293 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5294 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5295 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5296 @end deffn
5297
5298 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5299 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5300 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5301 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5302 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5303 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5304 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5305 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5306 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5307 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5308 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5309 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5310 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5311 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5312 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5313 @end deffn
5314
5315 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5316 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5317 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5318 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5319 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5320 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5321 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5322 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5323 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5324 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5325 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5326 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @anchor{targetevents}
5330 @section Target Events
5331 @cindex target events
5332 @cindex events
5333 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5334 For example:
5335 @itemize @bullet
5336 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5337 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5338 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5339 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5340 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5341 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5342 to set up system clocks or
5343 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5344 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5345 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5346 @end itemize
5347
5348 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5349 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5350 @command{target create ... -event}.
5351
5352 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5353 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5354 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5355
5356 @example
5357 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5358 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5359 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5360 @}
5361 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5362 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5363 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5364 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5365 @}
5366 @end example
5367
5368 The following target events are defined:
5369
5370 @itemize @bullet
5371 @item @b{debug-halted}
5372 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5373 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5374 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5375 @item @b{early-halted}
5376 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5377 @item @b{examine-start}
5378 @* Before target examine is called.
5379 @item @b{examine-end}
5380 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5381 @item @b{examine-fail}
5382 @* After target examine fails.
5383 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5384 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5385 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5386 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5387 connect GDB to running target.
5388 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5389 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5390 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5391 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5392 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5393 is in RAM or read only memory.
5394 Default is @code{halt}
5395 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5396 @* When GDB disconnects
5397 @item @b{gdb-end}
5398 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5399 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5400 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5401 @code{reset init})
5402 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5403 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5404 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5405 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5406 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5407 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5408 @item @b{gdb-start}
5409 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5410 @item @b{halted}
5411 @* The target has halted
5412 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5413 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5414 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5415 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5416 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5417 @item @b{reset-assert}
5418 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5419 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5420 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5421 it instead of asserting SRST.
5422 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5423 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5424 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5425 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5426 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5427 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5428 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5429 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5430 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5431 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5432 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5433 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5434 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5435 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5436 released on the scan chain.
5437 @item @b{reset-end}
5438 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5439 @item @b{reset-init}
5440 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5441 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5442
5443 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5444 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5445 multiplexing, and so on.
5446 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5447 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5448 @item @b{reset-start}
5449 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5450 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5451
5452 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5453 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5454 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5455 @item @b{resume-start}
5456 @* Before any target is resumed
5457 @item @b{resume-end}
5458 @* After all targets have resumed
5459 @item @b{resumed}
5460 @* Target has resumed
5461 @item @b{step-start}
5462 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5463 @item @b{step-end}
5464 @* After single-step has completed
5465 @item @b{trace-config}
5466 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5467 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5468 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5469 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5470 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5471 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5472 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5473 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5474 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5475 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5476 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5477 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5478 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5479 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5480 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5481 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5482 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5483 @end itemize
5484
5485 @quotation Note
5486 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5487 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5488 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5489 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5490 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5491 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5492 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5493 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5494 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5495 check if the core has changed status.
5496 @end quotation
5497
5498 @node Flash Commands
5499 @chapter Flash Commands
5500
5501 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5502 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5503 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5504 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5505 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5506 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5507 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5508 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5509 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5510
5511 Flash Steps:
5512 @enumerate
5513 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5514 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5515 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5516 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5517 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5518 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5519 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5520 @item GDB Flashing
5521 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5522 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5523 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5524 @end enumerate
5525
5526 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5527 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5528 so that it can't boot.
5529 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5530 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5531
5532 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5533 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5534 @cindex flash configuration
5535
5536 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5537 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5538 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5539 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5540 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5541 see the driver-specific documentation.
5542
5543 @itemize @bullet
5544 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5545 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5546 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5547 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5548 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5549 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5550 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5551 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5552 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5553 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5554 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5555 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5556 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5557 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5558 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5559 commands to the flash controller.
5560 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5561 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5562 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5563 for more information.
5564 @end itemize
5565 @quotation Note
5566 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5567 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5568 @end quotation
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5572 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5573 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5574 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5575 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5576 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5577 @end deffn
5578
5579 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5580 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5581 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5582 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5583 @end deffn
5584
5585 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5586 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5587 depends on the flash type.
5588 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5589 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5590 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5591 but most don't bother.
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5595
5596 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5597 begins.
5598
5599 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5600 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5601 until the programming session is finished.
5602
5603 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5604 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5605
5606 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5607
5608 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5609 @cindex flash erasing
5610 @cindex flash reading
5611 @cindex flash writing
5612 @cindex flash programming
5613 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5614
5615 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5616 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5617 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5618 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5619 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5620
5621 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5622 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5623 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5624 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5625 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5626
5627 @quotation Note
5628 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5629 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5630 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5631 back to a flash bank.
5632 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5633 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5634 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5635 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5636 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5637 @end quotation
5638
5639 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5640 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5641 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5642 disabled first.
5643 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5644 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5645 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5646
5647 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5648 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5649 up to and including @var{last}.
5650 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5651 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5652 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5653 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5657 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5658 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5659 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5660 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5661 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5662 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5663 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5664 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5665 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5666 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5667 before erase starts.
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5671 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5672 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5673 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5674 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5675 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5676 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5677 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5678 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5679 before issuing this command.
5680 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5681 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5682 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5683 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5684 @end deffn
5685 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5686
5687 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5688 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5689 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5690 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5691 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5692 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5693 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5694 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5695 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5696 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5697 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5698 @end deffn
5699
5700 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5701 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5702 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5703 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5708 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5709 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5710 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5711 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5716 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5717 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5718 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5719 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5720 @end deffn
5721
5722 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5723 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5724 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5725 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5726 to the base address for each section in the image.
5727 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5728 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5729 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5730 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5731 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5732 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5733 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5734 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5735 each image section.
5736
5737 @quotation Warning
5738 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5739 data you want to preserve.
5740 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5741 sections might be erased with no notice.
5742 @itemize
5743 @item
5744 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5745 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5746 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5747 @item
5748 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5749 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5750 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5751 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5752 @end itemize
5753 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5754 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5755 @end quotation
5756
5757 @end deffn
5758
5759 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5760 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5761 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5762 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5763 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5764 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5765 ordinary memory reads.
5766 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5767 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5768 check for successful programming.
5769 @end deffn
5770
5771 @section Other Flash commands
5772 @cindex flash protection
5773
5774 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5775 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5776 and display that status.
5777 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5781 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5782 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5783
5784 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5785 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5786 and possibly stale information.
5787 @end deffn
5788
5789 @anchor{flashprotect}
5790 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5791 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5792 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5793 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5794 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5795 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5796 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5797 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5798 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5799 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5800 @end deffn
5801
5802 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5803 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5804 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5805 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5806 @end deffn
5807
5808 @anchor{program}
5809 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5810 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5811 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5812 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5816 @section Flash Driver List
5817 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5818 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5819 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5820
5821 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5822 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5823 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5824
5825 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5826
5827 @itemize
5828 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5829 @end itemize
5830
5831 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5832 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5833 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5834 @example
5835 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5836 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5837 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5838 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5839 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5840 @end example
5841 @end deffn
5842
5843 @subsection External Flash
5844
5845 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5846 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5847 @cindex CFI
5848 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5849 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5850 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5851 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5852 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5853 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5854 configure a bus and its timings), or
5855 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5856 on the flash chip.
5857 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5858 speed up operation.
5859
5860 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5861
5862 @itemize
5863 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5864 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5865 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5866 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5867 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5868 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5869 @end itemize
5870
5871 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5872 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5873
5874 @example
5875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5876 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5877 @end example
5878
5879 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5880 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5881 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5882
5883 @example
5884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5885 @end example
5886
5887 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5888 @end deffn
5889
5890 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5891 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5892 @cindex SPI
5893 @cindex jtagspi
5894 @cindex bscan_spi
5895 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5896 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5897 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5898 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5899 accessed through JTAG.
5900
5901 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5902 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5903 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5904 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5905 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5906 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5907
5908 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5909 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5910 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5911 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5912 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5913 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5914 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5915 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5916
5917 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5918 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5919 command, see below.
5920
5921 @itemize
5922 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5923 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5924 @var{USER1} instruction.
5925 @end itemize
5926
5927 @example
5928 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5929 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5931 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5932 @end example
5933
5934 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5935 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5936 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5937 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5938 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5939 @example
5940 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5941 @end example
5942 @end deffn
5943
5944 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5945 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5946 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5947 @example
5948 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5949 @end example
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5953 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5954 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5955 @end deffn
5956 @end deffn
5957
5958 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5959 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5960 @cindex xcf
5961 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5962 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5963 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5964 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5965 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5966
5967 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5968 command accepts additional parameters:
5969 @itemize
5970 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5971 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5972 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5973 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5974 in master mode.
5975 @end itemize
5976 @example
5977 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5978 @end example
5979 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5980 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5981 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5982 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5983 dedicated sector.
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5987 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5988 button.
5989 @example
5990 xcf configure 0
5991 @end example
5992 @end deffn
5993
5994 Additional driver notes:
5995 @itemize
5996 @item Only single revision supported.
5997 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5998 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5999 (Intel hex) file types supported.
6000 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
6001 @end itemize
6002 @end deffn
6003
6004 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
6005 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
6006 @cindex SPIFI
6007 @cindex lpcspifi
6008 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
6009 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
6010 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
6011
6012 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
6013 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
6014 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
6015 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
6016 significantly reduce flash programming times.
6017
6018 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
6019 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
6020 are configured by the driver.
6021
6022 @example
6023 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6024 @end example
6025
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
6029 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
6030 @cindex SMI
6031 @cindex stmsmi
6032 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
6033 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
6034 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
6035 SPI flash devices.
6036 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
6037 flash devices can be connected.
6038
6039 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
6040 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
6041 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
6042 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6043 the flash content.
6044
6045 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6046 to identify the memory bank.
6047 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
6048 flash size, are detected automatically.
6049
6050 @example
6051 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6052 @end example
6053
6054 @end deffn
6055
6056 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
6057 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
6058 @cindex QuadSPI
6059 @cindex OctoSPI
6060 @cindex stmqspi
6061 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
6062 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
6063 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
6064 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
6065 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
6066 mode is not.
6067
6068 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
6069 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
6070 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
6071 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
6072
6073 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
6074 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
6075 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6076
6077 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6078 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6079 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6080 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6081 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6082 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6083
6084 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6085 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6086 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6087 should be avoided.
6088
6089 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6090 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6091 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6092 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6093 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6094 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6095
6096 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6097 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6098 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6099 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6100 persist across openocd invocations.
6101
6102 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6103 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6104 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6105 required (see 'set' command).
6106
6107 @example
6108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6109 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6110 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6111 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6112 @end example
6113
6114 There are three specific commands
6115 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6116 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6117 chip specific write protection engaged.
6118 @end deffn
6119
6120 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6121 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6122 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6123 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6124 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6125 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6126
6127 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6128 which don't support an id command.
6129
6130 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6131 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6135 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6136 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6137 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6138 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6139
6140 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6141 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6142 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6143 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6144
6145 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6146
6147 To check basic communication settings, issue
6148 @example
6149 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6150 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6151 @end example
6152 for single flash mode or
6153 @example
6154 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6155 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6156 @end example
6157 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6158
6159 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6160 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6161 need a dummy address, e.g.
6162 @example
6163 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6164 @end example
6165 should return the status register contents.
6166
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @end deffn
6170
6171 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6172 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6173 Microcontroller platform.
6174
6175 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6176 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6177
6178 @example
6179 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6180 @end example
6181
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6185 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6186 @cindex ath79
6187 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6188 chip selects.
6189 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6190 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6191 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6192 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6193 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6194 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6195
6196 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6197 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6198 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6199 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6200 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6201 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6202 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6203 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6204 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6205 with the default CS0.
6206 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6207 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6208 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6209
6210 @example
6211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6212
6213 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6214 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6215 # distinguish the banks.
6216 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6217 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6218 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6219 @end example
6220
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6224 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6225 @cindex fespi
6226
6227 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6228
6229 @example
6230 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6231 @end example
6232 @end deffn
6233
6234 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6235
6236 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6237 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6238 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6239 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6240 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6241 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6242
6243 @example
6244 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6245 @end example
6246 @end deffn
6247
6248 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6249 @cindex ambiqmicro
6250 @cindex apollo
6251 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6252 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6253 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6254 with the target using SWD.
6255
6256 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6257 the device class of the MCU.
6258 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6259 to set up the flash banks.
6260 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6261 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6262
6263 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6264 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6265 and the second bank starts after the first.
6266
6267 @example
6268 # Flash bank 0
6269 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6270 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6271 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6272 $_TARGETNAME
6273 @end example
6274
6275 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6276 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6277 are available to the user.
6278
6279 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6280
6281 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6282 Erase entire bank.
6283 @end deffn
6284 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6285 Erase device pages.
6286 @end deffn
6287 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6288 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6289 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6290 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6291 the flash.
6292 @end deffn
6293 @end deffn
6294
6295 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6296 @cindex at91samd
6297 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6298 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6299
6300 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6301
6302 The devices have one flash bank:
6303
6304 @example
6305 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6306 @end example
6307
6308 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6309 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6310 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6311 processor to be halted.
6312 @end deffn
6313
6314 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6315 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6316 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6317 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6318 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6319 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6320
6321 @example
6322 at91samd set-security enable
6323 @end example
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6327 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6328 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6329 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6330 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6331 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6332 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6333 in order to disable this feature.
6334
6335 @example
6336 at91samd eeprom
6337 at91samd eeprom 1024
6338 @end example
6339 @end deffn
6340
6341 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6342 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6343 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6344 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6345 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6346 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6347
6348 @example
6349 at91samd bootloader
6350 at91samd bootloader 16384
6351 @end example
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6355 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6356 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6357 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6358 @end deffn
6359
6360 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6361 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6362 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6363 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6364 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6365 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6366 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6367 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6368
6369 @example
6370 # Read user row
6371 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6372 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6373 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6374 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6375 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6376 # byte unchanged
6377 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6378 @end example
6379 @end deffn
6380
6381 @end deffn
6382
6383 @anchor{at91sam3}
6384 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6385 @cindex at91sam3
6386 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6387 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6388 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6389 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6390 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6391 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6392 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6393 chips are confirmed.}
6394
6395 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6396 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6397 the following fixed locations:
6398
6399 @example
6400 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6401 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6402 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6403 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6404 @end example
6405
6406 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6407 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6408 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6409
6410 @itemize
6411 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6412 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6413 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6414 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6415 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6416 @end itemize
6417
6418 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6419
6420 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6421 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6422 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6423 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6424 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6425 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6426 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6427
6428 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6429 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6430 @end deffn
6431
6432 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6433 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6434 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6435 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6436 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6437 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6438 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6439 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6443 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6444 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6445 @end deffn
6446 @end deffn
6447
6448 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6449 @cindex at91sam4
6450 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6451 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6452 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6453 @end deffn
6454
6455 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6456 @cindex at91sam4l
6457 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6458 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6459 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6460
6461 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6462 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6463 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6464 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6465 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6466 @end deffn
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @anchor{atsame5}
6470 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6471 @cindex atsame5
6472 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6473 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6474 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6475
6476 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6477 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6478 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6479
6480 @example
6481 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6482 @end example
6483
6484 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6485 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6486 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6487 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6488 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6489 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6490
6491 @example
6492 atsame5 bootloader
6493 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6494 @end example
6495 @end deffn
6496
6497 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6498 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6499 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6500 processor to be halted.
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6504 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6505 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6506 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6510 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6511 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6512 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6513 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6514 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6515 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6516 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6517
6518 @example
6519 # Read
6520 >atsame5 userpage
6521 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6522 # Write
6523 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6524 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6525 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6526 # bytes)
6527 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6528 @end example
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6534 @cindex atsamv
6535 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6536 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6537 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6538
6539 @example
6540 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6541 @end example
6542
6543 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6544 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6545 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6546 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6547 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6548
6549 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6550 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @end deffn
6554
6555 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6556 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6557 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6558 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6559 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6560
6561 @example
6562 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6563 @end example
6564
6565 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6566 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6567
6568 @itemize
6569 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6570 @item @var{banks}
6571 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6572 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6573 @item @var{pages_size}
6574 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6575 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6576 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6577 @end itemize
6578
6579 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6580 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6581 will be autoconfigured.
6582 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6583
6584 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6585 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6586 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6587 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6588 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6589
6590 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6591 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6592 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6593 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6594 are not truly general purpose).
6595 @quotation Note
6596 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6597 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6598 @end quotation
6599 @end deffn
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6603 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6604 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6605 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6606 @end deffn
6607
6608 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6609 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6610 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6611 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6612
6613 @example
6614 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6615 @end example
6616
6617 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6618 each single sector one by one.
6619
6620 @example
6621 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6622 @end example
6623
6624 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6625 @end deffn
6626
6627 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6628 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6629 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6630 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6631 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6632 starts at address 0.
6633
6634 @example
6635 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6636 @end example
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6640 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6641 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6642 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6643 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6644 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6645 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6646 and programming the serial flash.
6647
6648 @example
6649 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6650 @end example
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6654 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6655 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6656 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6657 autoconfigures itself.
6658 @example
6659 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6660 @end example
6661 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6662 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6663 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6664 currently not supported.
6665 @example
6666 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6667 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6668 @end example
6669
6670 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6671 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6672 this via the following command:
6673 @example
6674 efm32 debuglock num
6675 @end example
6676 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6677 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6678 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6679 supported.}
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6683 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6684 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6685 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6686 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6687 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6688
6689 @example
6690 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6691 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6692 @end example
6693
6694 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6695 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6696 @end deffn
6697
6698 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6699 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6700 is an uncommon operation.}
6701 @end deffn
6702 @end deffn
6703
6704 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6705 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6706 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6707 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6708 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6709 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6710 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6711
6712 @example
6713 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6714 @end example
6715 @end deffn
6716
6717 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6718 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6719 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6720 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6721 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6722 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6723 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6724 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6725 characters) ignored.
6726
6727 @example
6728 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6729 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6730 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6731 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6732 @end example
6733 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6734 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6735 @end deffn
6736
6737 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6738 @cindex kinetis
6739 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6740 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6741 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6742 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6743 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6744 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6745
6746 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6747 @itemize
6748 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6749 @end itemize
6750
6751 @example
6752 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6753 @end example
6754
6755 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6756 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6757 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6758 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6762 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6763 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6764 set by 'flash protect' command.
6765 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6766 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6767 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6768 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6769 with the rest of a flash image.
6770 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6774 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6775 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6779 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6780 and examine-fail event.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6784 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6785 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6786 @end deffn
6787
6788 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6789 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6790 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6791 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6792 command completes.
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6796 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6797 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6798 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6799 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6800
6801 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6802 Program Partition command.
6803
6804 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6805 Reset the device after partition setting.
6806
6807 Show partition size:
6808 @example
6809 kinetis nvm_partition info
6810 @end example
6811
6812 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6813 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6814 @example
6815 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6816 @end example
6817
6818 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6819 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6820 @example
6821 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6822 @end example
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6826 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6827 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6828 @end deffn
6829
6830 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6831 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6832 Command disables watchdog timer.
6833 @end deffn
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6837 @cindex kinetis_ke
6838 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6839 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6840 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6841 autoconfigures itself.
6842 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6843
6844 @example
6845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6846 @end example
6847
6848 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6849 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6850 @end deffn
6851
6852 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6853 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6854 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6855 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6856 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6860 Command disables watchdog timer.
6861 @end deffn
6862 @end deffn
6863
6864 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6865 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6866 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6867 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6868 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6869
6870 @quotation Note
6871 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6872 driver:
6873 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6874 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6875 @end quotation
6876
6877 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6878 which must appear in the following order:
6879
6880 @itemize
6881 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6882 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6883 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6884 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6885 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6886 LPC43x[2357])
6887 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6888 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6889 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6890 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6891 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6892 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6893 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6894 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6895 at which the core is running
6896 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6897 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6898 @quotation Note
6899 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6900 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6901 However, if you do provide it,
6902 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6903 @end quotation
6904 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6905 ROM IAP entry point.
6906 @end itemize
6907
6908 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6909
6910 @example
6911 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6912 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6913 @end example
6914
6915 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6916 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6917 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6918 @end deffn
6919 @end deffn
6920
6921 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6922 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6923 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6924 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6925 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6926 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6927
6928 @example
6929 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6930 @end example
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6934 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6935 from NXP.
6936
6937 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6938 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6939 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6940 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6941 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6942 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6943 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6944 you start the PLL.
6945
6946 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6947
6948 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6949 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6950 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6951
6952 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6953 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6954 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6955 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6956 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6957 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6958 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6959
6960 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6961 @example
6962 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6963 @end example
6964
6965 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6966 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6967 @code{flash banks} command.
6968
6969 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6970 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6971 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6972 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6973 a known signature.
6974 Example:
6975 @example
6976 lpc2900 signature 0
6977 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6978 @end example
6979 @end deffn
6980
6981 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6982 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6983 saves it to a file in binary format.
6984 Example:
6985 @example
6986 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6987 @end example
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6991 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6992 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6993 command:
6994
6995 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6996 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6997 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6998 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6999
7000 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
7001 Example:
7002 @example
7003 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
7004 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
7005 @end example
7006 @end deffn
7007
7008 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
7009 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
7010 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
7011 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
7012 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
7013 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
7014 912 bytes.
7015 @quotation Attention
7016 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7017 @end quotation
7018 Example:
7019 @example
7020 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
7021 @end example
7022 @end deffn
7023
7024 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
7025 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
7026 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
7027 after the next power cycle.
7028 @quotation Attention
7029 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7030 @end quotation
7031 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
7032 Example:
7033 @example
7034 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
7035 flash info 0
7036 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
7037 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7038 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
7039 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7040 @end example
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
7044 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
7045 effective after the next power cycle.
7046 @quotation Attention
7047 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7048 @end quotation
7049 Examples:
7050 @example
7051 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
7052 @end example
7053 @end deffn
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
7057 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
7058 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
7059 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
7060
7061 @example
7062 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
7063 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
7064 @end example
7065
7066 @itemize @bullet
7067 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
7068 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
7069 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
7070 @end itemize
7071
7072 Example usage:
7073 @example
7074 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
7075 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7076 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7077 @} else @{
7078 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7079 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7080 @}
7081 @end example
7082 @end deffn
7083
7084 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7085 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7086 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7087 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7088 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7089 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7090
7091 @example
7092 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7093 @end example
7094
7095 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7096 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7097 only the main program flash.
7098
7099 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7100 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7101 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7105 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7106 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7107 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7108
7109 To erase and program the BSL:
7110 @example
7111 msp432 bsl unlock
7112 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7113 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7114 msp432 bsl lock
7115 @end example
7116 @end deffn
7117 @end deffn
7118
7119 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7120 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7121 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7122 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7123 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7124 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7125 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7126 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7127 also have division into regions: main and info.
7128 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7129 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7130
7131 @example
7132 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7133 @end example
7134
7135 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7136
7137 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7138 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7142 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7146 Erase all userflash including info region.
7147 @end deffn
7148
7149 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7150 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7151 @end deffn
7152
7153 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7154 Check sectors protect.
7155 @end deffn
7156
7157 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7158 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7159 @end deffn
7160
7161 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7162 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7163 @end deffn
7164
7165 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7166 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7170 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7174 Show information about flash driver.
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @end deffn
7178
7179 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7180 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7181 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7182 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7183 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7184
7185 @example
7186 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7187 @end example
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7191 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7192 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7193 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7194 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7195 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7196 - ACL).
7197
7198 @example
7199 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7200 @end example
7201
7202 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7203
7204 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7205 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7206 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7207 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7208 code.
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7212 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @end deffn
7216
7217 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7218 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7219 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7220
7221 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7222 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7223 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7224 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7225
7226 @example
7227 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7228 @end example
7229 @end deffn
7230
7231 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7232 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7233 and integrate flash memory.
7234
7235 @example
7236 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7238 @end example
7239
7240 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7241 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7242 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7243 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7244 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7245 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7246 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7247 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7248 @end deffn
7249 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7250 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7251 This will remove any Code Protection.
7252 @end deffn
7253 @end deffn
7254
7255 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7256 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7257 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7258 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7259 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7260
7261 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7262 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7263
7264 @example
7265 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7266 @end example
7267
7268 psoc4-specific commands
7269 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7270 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7271
7272 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7273 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7274
7275 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7276 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7277 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7278
7279 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7283 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7284
7285 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7286 @end deffn
7287 @end deffn
7288
7289 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7290 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7291 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7292 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7293 apart from the base address.
7294
7295 @example
7296 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7297 @end example
7298
7299 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7300 @quotation Attention
7301 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7302 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7303 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7304 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7305 @end quotation
7306
7307 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7308
7309 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7310 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7311 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7312 @end deffn
7313 @end deffn
7314
7315 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7316 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7317 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7318 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7319 apart from the base address.
7320
7321 @example
7322 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7323 $_TARGETNAME
7324 @end example
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7328 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7329 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7330 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7331
7332 @example
7333 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7334 @end example
7335
7336 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7337
7338 @itemize
7339 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7340 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7341 @end itemize
7342
7343 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7344
7345 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7346 @quotation Attention
7347 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7348 after successful write.
7349 @end quotation
7350 @end deffn
7351
7352 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7353 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7354 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7355 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7356
7357 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7358 @itemize @bullet
7359 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7360 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7361 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7362 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7363 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7364 row size: 512 bytes.
7365 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7366 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7367 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7368 operation will erase row automatically.
7369 @end itemize
7370
7371 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7372 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7373
7374 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7375
7376 @example
7377 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7378 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7379 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7380 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7381 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7382 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7383 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7384 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7385 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7386 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7387 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7388 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7389
7390 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7391 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7392 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7393 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7394 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7395 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7396 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7397 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7398 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7399 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7400 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7401 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7402 @end example
7403
7404 psoc6-specific commands
7405 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7406 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7407 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7408 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7409 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7410 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7414 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7415 by @command{flash banks}.
7416 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7417 @end deffn
7418 @end deffn
7419
7420 @deffn {Flash Driver} {qn908x}
7421 The NXP QN908x microcontrollers feature a Cortex-M4F with integrated Bluetooth
7422 LE 5 support and an internal flash of up to 512 KiB. These chips only support
7423 the SWD interface.
7424
7425 The @var{qn908x} driver uses the internal "Flash Memory Controller" block via
7426 SWD to erase, program and read the internal flash. This driver does not
7427 support the ISP (In-System Programming) mode which is an alternate way to
7428 program the flash via UART, SPI or USB.
7429
7430 The internal flash is 512 KiB in size in all released chips and it starts at
7431 the address 0x01000000, although it can be mapped to address 0 and it is
7432 aliased to other addresses. This driver only recognizes the bank starting at
7433 address 0x01000000.
7434
7435 The internal bootloader stored in ROM is in charge of loading and verifying
7436 the image from flash, or enter ISP mode. The programmed image must start at
7437 the beginning of the flash and contain a valid header and a matching CRC32
7438 checksum. Additionally, the image header contains a "Code Read Protection"
7439 (CRP) word which indicates whether SWD access is enabled, as well as whether
7440 ISP mode is enabled. Therefore, it is possible to program an image that
7441 disables SWD and ISP making it impossible to program another image in the
7442 future through these interfaces, or even debug the current image. While this is
7443 a valid use case for production deployments where the chips are locked down, by
7444 default this driver doesn't allow such images that disable the SWD interface.
7445 To program such images see the @command{qn908x allow_brick} command.
7446
7447 Apart from the CRP field which is located in the image header, the last page
7448 of the flash memory contains a "Flash lock and protect" descriptor which allows
7449 to individually protect each 2 KiB page, as well as disabling SWD access to the
7450 flash and RAM. If this access is disabled it is not possible to read, erase or
7451 program individual pages from the SWD interface or even access the read-only
7452 "Flash information page" with information about the bootloader version and
7453 flash size. However when this protection is in place, it is still possible to
7454 mass erase the whole chip and then program a new image, for which you can use
7455 the @command{qn908x mass_erase}.
7456
7457 Example:
7458 @example
7459 flash bank $FLASHNAME qn908x 0x01000000 0 0 0 $TARGETNAME calc_checksum
7460 @end example
7461
7462 Parameters:
7463 @itemize
7464 @item @option{calc_checksum} optional parameter to compute the required
7465 checksum of the first bytes in the vector table.
7466 @quotation Note
7467 If the checksum in the header of your image is invalid and you don't provide the
7468 @option{calc_checksum} option the boot ROM will not boot your image and it may
7469 render the flash inaccessible. On the other hand, if you use this option to
7470 compute the checksum keep in mind that @command{verify_image} will fail on
7471 those four bytes of the checksum since those bytes in the flash will have the
7472 updated checksum.
7473 @end quotation
7474 @end itemize
7475
7476 @deffn {Command} {qn908x allow_brick}
7477 Allow the qn908x driver to program images with a "Code Read Protection" byte
7478 that disables the SWD access. Programming such image will cause OpenOCD to
7479 not be able to reach the target over SWD anymore after the new image is
7480 programmed and its configuration takes effect, e.g. after a reboot. After
7481 executing @command{qn908x allow_brick} these images will be allowed to be
7482 programmed when writing to the flash.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn {Command} {qn908x disable_wdog}
7486 Disable the watchdog timer (WDT) by resetting its CTRL field. The WDT starts
7487 enabled after a @command{reset halt} and it doesn't run while the target is
7488 halted. However, the verification process in this driver uses the generic
7489 Cortex-M verification process which executes a payload in RAM and thus
7490 requires the watchdog to be disabled before running @command{verify_image}
7491 after a reset halt or any other condition where the watchdog is running.
7492 Note that this is not done automatically and you must run this command in
7493 those scenarios.
7494 @end deffn
7495
7496 @deffn {Command} {qn908x mass_erase}
7497 Erases the complete flash using the mass_erase method. Mass erase is only
7498 allowed if enabled in the Lock Status Register 8 (LOCK_STAT_8) which is read
7499 from the last sector of the flash on boot. However, this mass_erase lock
7500 protection can be bypassed and this command does so automatically.
7501
7502 In the same LOCK_STAT_8 the flash and RAM access from SWD can be disabled by
7503 setting two bits in this register. After a mass_erase, all the bits of the
7504 flash would be set, making it the default to restrict SWD access to the flash
7505 and RAM regions. This new after erase LOCK_STAT_8 value only takes effect after
7506 being read from flash on the next reboot for example. After a mass_erase the
7507 LOCK_STAT_8 register is changed by the hardware to allow access to flash and
7508 RAM regardless of the value on flash, but only right after a mass_erase and
7509 until the next boot. Therefore it is possible to perform a mass_erase, program
7510 a new image, verify it and then reboot to a valid image that's locked from the
7511 SWD access.
7512
7513 The @command{qn908x mass_erase} command clears the bits that would be loaded
7514 from the flash into LOCK_STAT_8 after erasing the whole chip to allow SWD
7515 access for debugging or re-flashing an image without a mass_erase by default.
7516 If the image being programmed also programs the last page of the flash with its
7517 own settings, this mass_erase behavior will interfere with that write since a
7518 new erase of at least the last page would need to be performed before writing
7519 to it again. For this reason the optional @option{keep_lock} argument can be
7520 used to leave the flash and RAM lock set. For development environments, the
7521 default behavior is desired.
7522
7523 The mass erase locking mechanism is independent from the individual page
7524 locking bits, so it is possible that you can't erase a given page that is
7525 locked and you can't unprotect that page because the locking bits are also
7526 locked, but can still mass erase the whole flash.
7527 @end deffn
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7531 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7532 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7533 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7534 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7535
7536 @example
7537 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7538 @end example
7539 @end deffn
7540
7541 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rsl10}
7542 Supports Onsemi RSL10 microcontroller flash memory. Uses functions
7543 stored in ROM to control flash memory interface.
7544
7545 @example
7546 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rsl10 $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7547 @end example
7548
7549 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 lock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7550 Writes @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to @var{0x81044 0x81048 0x8104c
7551 0x8050}. Locks debug port by writing @var{0x4C6F634B} to @var{0x81040}.
7552
7553 To unlock use the @command{rsl10 unlock key1 key2 key3 key4} command.
7554 @end deffn
7555
7556 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 unlock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7557 Unlocks debug port, by writing @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to
7558 registers through DAP, and clears @var{0x81040} address in flash to 0x1.
7559 @end deffn
7560
7561 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 mass_erase}
7562 Erases all unprotected flash sectors.
7563 @end deffn
7564 @end deffn
7565
7566 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7567 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7568 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7569 and SWD interface.
7570 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7571 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7572
7573 @example
7574 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7575 @end example
7576
7577 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7578
7579 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7580 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7581 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7585 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7586 @end deffn
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7590 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7591 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7592 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7593 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7594
7595 @example
7596 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7597 @end example
7598
7599 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7600 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7601 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7602 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7603 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7604 disabled.
7605
7606 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7607 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7608 @quotation Warning
7609 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7610 applied to all of them.
7611 @end quotation
7612 @end deffn
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7616 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7617 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7618 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7619 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7620 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7621 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7622
7623 @example
7624 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7625 @end example
7626
7627 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7628 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7629 the flash driver.
7630
7631 @example
7632 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7633 @end example
7634
7635 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7636 as per the following example.
7637 @example
7638 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7639 @end example
7640
7641 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7642
7643 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7644 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7645 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7649 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7650 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7651 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7655 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7656 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7657 @end deffn
7658
7659 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7660 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7661 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7662 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7663 @end deffn
7664
7665 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7666 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7667 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7668 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7669 @end deffn
7670
7671 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7672 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7673 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7674 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7675 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7676 @end deffn
7677 @end deffn
7678
7679 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7680 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7681 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7682 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7683 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7684
7685 @example
7686 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7687 @end example
7688
7689 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7690 as per the following example.
7691 @example
7692 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7693 @end example
7694
7695 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7696 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7697 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7698 @end deffn
7699
7700 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7701 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7702 the flash driver.
7703
7704 @example
7705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7706 @end example
7707
7708 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7709
7710 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7711 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7713 @end deffn
7714
7715 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7716 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7721 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7726 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7727 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7728 @end deffn
7729
7730 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7731 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7732 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7733 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7734 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7735 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7736 @end deffn
7737
7738 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7739 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7740 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7741 @end deffn
7742 @end deffn
7743
7744 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7745 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7746 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7747 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7748 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7749
7750 @example
7751 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7752 @end example
7753
7754 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7755 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7756 the flash driver.
7757
7758 @example
7759 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7760 @end example
7761
7762 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7763
7764 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7765 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7766 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7770 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7771 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7772 @end deffn
7773
7774 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7775 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7776 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7780 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7781 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7782 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7783 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7784
7785 Example usage:
7786 @example
7787 # read OPTSR_CUR
7788 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7789 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7790 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7791 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7792 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7793 @end example
7794 @end deffn
7795
7796 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7797 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7798 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7799 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7800 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7801 will be touched).
7802
7803 Example usage:
7804 @example
7805 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7806 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7807 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7808 @end example
7809 @end deffn
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7813 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7814 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7815 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7816 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7817
7818 @example
7819 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7820 @end example
7821
7822 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7823 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7824 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7825 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7826 second bank.
7827
7828 @example
7829 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7830 @end example
7831
7832 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7833
7834 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7835 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7836 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7840 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7841 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7845 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7846 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7847 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7848 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7849 @end deffn
7850 @end deffn
7851
7852 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7853 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7854 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7855 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7856 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7857 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7858
7859 @example
7860 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7861 @end example
7862
7863 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7864 as per the following example.
7865 @example
7866 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7867 @end example
7868
7869 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7870 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7871 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7872 @end deffn
7873
7874 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7875 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7876 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7877 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7878
7879 @example
7880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7881 @end example
7882
7883 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7884
7885 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7886 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7887 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7888
7889 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7893 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7894 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7895
7896 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7900 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7901 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7902 @end deffn
7903
7904 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7905 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7906 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7907 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7908
7909 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7910 @example
7911 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7912 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7913 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7914 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7915 @end example
7916
7917 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7918 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7919 @end deffn
7920
7921 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7922 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7923 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7924 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7925 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7926
7927 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7928
7929 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7930 @example
7931 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7932 @end example
7933
7934 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7935 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7936 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7937 @end deffn
7938
7939 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7940 List the protected areas using WRP.
7941 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7942 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7943 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7944
7945 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7946 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7947 in single or dual-banks mode.
7948 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7949 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7950
7951 @end deffn
7952
7953 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7954 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7955 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7956 @end deffn
7957
7958 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7959 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7960 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7961 the TrustZone status.
7962 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7963 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7964 @end deffn
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7968 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7969 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7970 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7971 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7972
7973 @example
7974 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7975 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7976 @end example
7977
7978 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7979 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7980 for the specified flash bank.
7981 @end deffn
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7985 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7986 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7987 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7988 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7989
7990 @example
7991 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7992 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7993 @end example
7994
7995 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7996 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7997 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7998
7999 @itemize @bullet
8000 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
8001 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
8002 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
8003 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
8004 @end itemize
8005 @end deffn
8006
8007 @end deffn
8008
8009 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
8010 @cindex str9xpec
8011
8012 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
8013 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
8014 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
8015 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
8016
8017 Here is some background info to help
8018 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
8019 the str9:
8020 @enumerate
8021 @item
8022 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
8023 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
8024 @item
8025 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
8026 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
8027 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
8028 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
8029 @end enumerate
8030
8031 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
8032 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
8033 configured for flash bank 0.
8034 @example
8035 # assert srst, we do not want core running
8036 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
8037 adapter assert srst
8038 # turn off target polling
8039 poll off
8040 # disable str9 core
8041 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
8042 # read option bytes
8043 str9xpec options_read 0
8044 # re-enable str9 core
8045 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
8046 poll on
8047 reset halt
8048 @end example
8049 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
8050 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
8051 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
8052 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
8053
8054 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
8055
8056 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
8057 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
8061 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
8062 directly to the embedded flash controller.
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
8066 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
8067 erase the device.
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
8071 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
8075 Configure str9 boot bank.
8076 @end deffn
8077
8078 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8079 Configure str9 lvd source.
8080 @end deffn
8081
8082 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
8083 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8087 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
8088 @end deffn
8089
8090 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
8091 Read str9 option bytes.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
8095 Write str9 option bytes.
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
8099 unlock str9 device.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
8105 @cindex swm050
8106 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
8107
8108 @example
8109 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
8110 @end example
8111
8112 One swm050-specific command is defined:
8113
8114 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
8115 Erases the entire flash bank.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120
8121 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
8122 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
8123 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8124 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8125
8126 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
8127
8128 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
8129 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
8130 @end deffn
8131
8132 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
8133 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
8134 @end deffn
8135
8136 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
8137 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
8138 the flash clock.
8139 @end deffn
8140 @end deffn
8141
8142 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
8143 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
8144 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
8145 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
8146 correct bank config.
8147
8148 @example
8149 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
8150 @end example
8151 @end deffn
8152
8153 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
8154 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8155 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8156 @end deffn
8157
8158 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
8159 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8160 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8161
8162 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
8163
8164 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
8165 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
8166 @end deffn
8167
8168 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8169 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8170 @end deffn
8171
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @section NAND Flash Commands
8175 @cindex NAND
8176
8177 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8178 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8179 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8180
8181 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8182 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8183 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8184 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8185 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8186 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8187
8188 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8189 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8190 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8191 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8192 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8193 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8194 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8195 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8196 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8197 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8198
8199 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8200 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8201 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8202 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8203 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8204 every 512 bytes of data.
8205
8206 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8207 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8208 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8209 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8210 ECC mode is used.
8211
8212 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8213 @enumerate
8214 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8215 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8216 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8217 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8218 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8219 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8220 to access that device.
8221 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8222 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8223 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8224 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8225 de-brick a board.
8226 @end enumerate
8227
8228 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8229 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8230 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8231 are only 32 bits wide.
8232 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8233 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8234 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8235 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8236
8237 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8238 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8239 @cindex NAND configuration
8240
8241 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8242 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8243 OpenOCD has initialized.
8244
8245 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8246 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8247 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8248 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8249 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8250 they were a single (larger) device.
8251 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8252 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8253
8254 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8255 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8256 configuration files, not interactively.
8257
8258 @itemize @bullet
8259 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8260 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8261 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8262 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8263 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8264 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8265 commands to the NAND controller.
8266 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8267 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8268 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8269 for more information.
8270 @end itemize
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8274 Prints a summary of each device declared
8275 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8276 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8277 @example
8278 > nand list
8279 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8280 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8281 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8282 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8283 >
8284 @end example
8285 @end deffn
8286
8287 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8288 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8289 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8290 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8291 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8292 it with most other NAND commands.
8293 @end deffn
8294
8295 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8296
8297 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8298 @cindex NAND reading
8299 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8300 starting at the specified offset.
8301 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8302
8303 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8304 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8305
8306 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8307 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8308 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8309
8310 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8311 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8312 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8313 method which handled that error correction.
8314
8315 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8316 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8317 @itemize @bullet
8318 @item no oob_* parameter
8319 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8320 @item @code{oob_raw}
8321 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8322 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8323 spare areas associated with each data page.
8324 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8325 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8326 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8327 @item @code{oob_only}
8328 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8329 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8330 spare areas associated with each data page.
8331 @end itemize
8332 @end deffn
8333
8334 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8335 @cindex NAND erasing
8336 @cindex NAND programming
8337 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8338 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8339 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8340 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8341 If those parameters are not specified,
8342 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8343 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8344
8345 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8346 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8347 block marker.
8348 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8349 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8350 @end deffn
8351
8352 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8353 @cindex NAND writing
8354 @cindex NAND programming
8355 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8356 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8357 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8358 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8359
8360 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8361 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8362
8363 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8364 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8365 past the end of the device.
8366 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8367 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8368 if that's being written.)
8369
8370 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8371 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8372 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8373
8374 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8375 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8376 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8377 @itemize @bullet
8378 @item no oob_* parameter
8379 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8380 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8381 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8382 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8383 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8384 @item @code{oob_only}
8385 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8386 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8387 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8388 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8389 @item @code{oob_raw}
8390 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8391 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8392 un-altered OOB.
8393 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8394 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8395 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8396 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8397 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8398 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8399 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8400 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8401 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8402 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8403 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8404 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8405 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8406 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8407 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8408 @end itemize
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8412 @cindex NAND verification
8413 @cindex NAND programming
8414 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8415 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8416 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8417
8418 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8419 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8420
8421 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8422 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8423 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8424 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8425 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8426
8427 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8428 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8429 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8430
8431 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8432 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8433 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8434 be removed in a future release.
8435 @end deffn
8436
8437 @subsection Other NAND commands
8438 @cindex NAND other commands
8439
8440 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8441 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8442 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8443 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8444 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8445 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8446 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8447 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8448
8449 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8450 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8451 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8452 @end deffn
8453
8454 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8455 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8456 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8457 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8458 status for each block.
8459 @end deffn
8460
8461 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8462 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8463 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8464
8465 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8466 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8467 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8468 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8469 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8470
8471 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8472 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8473 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8474 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8475 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8476 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8477 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8481 @subsection NAND Driver List
8482 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8483 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8484 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8485
8486 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8487 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8488 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8489 address of the ECC controller.
8490 @example
8491 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8492 @end example
8493 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8494 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8495 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8496 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8497 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8498 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8499 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8500 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8501 @end deffn
8502 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8503 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8504 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8505 @end deffn
8506
8507 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8508 properly configured for input or output.
8509 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8510 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8511 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8512 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8513 @end deffn
8514 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8515 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8516 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8517 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8518 @end deffn
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8522 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8523 chips from Texas Instruments.
8524 It takes three extra parameters:
8525 address of the NAND chip;
8526 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8527 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8528 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8529 @example
8530 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8531 @end example
8532 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8533 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8534 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8535 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8536 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8540 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8541 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8542 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8543 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8544 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8545 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8549 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8550 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8551 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8552 @end deffn
8553 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8554
8555 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8556 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8557 should work for this chip as well.
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8561 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8562 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8563 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8564 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8565 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8566 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8567 @example
8568 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8569 @end example
8570 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8571 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8572 without parameter query status.
8573 @end deffn
8574 @end deffn
8575
8576 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8577 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8578 parameter: the address of the controller.
8579 @example
8580 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8581 @end example
8582 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8583 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8584 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8585 change any behavior.
8586 @end deffn
8587
8588 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8589 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8590 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8591 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8592 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8593 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8594 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8595 specialized commands.
8596 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8597 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8598 change any behavior.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @node Flash Programming
8602 @chapter Flash Programming
8603
8604 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8605 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8606 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8607
8608 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8609 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8610
8611 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8612 @enumerate
8613 @item 'init' is executed.
8614 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8615 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8616 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8617 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8618 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8619 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8620 @end enumerate
8621
8622 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8623
8624 @example
8625 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8626 # are optional parameters
8627 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8628 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8629
8630 # binary files need the flash address passing
8631 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8632 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8633 @end example
8634
8635 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8636 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8637 @cindex PLD
8638 @cindex FPGA
8639
8640 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8641 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8642 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8643 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8644 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8645 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8646 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8647
8648 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8649
8650 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8651 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8652 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8653
8654 They are referenced by the name which was given when the pld was created or
8655 the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command.
8656 New PLDs are defined by @command{pld create pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]}.
8657
8658 @deffn {Config Command} {pld create} pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]
8659 Creates a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8660 assigning @var{pld_name} for further reference.
8661 @code{-chain-position} @var{tap_name} names the TAP
8662 used to access this target.
8663 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its behavior.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8667 List the known PLDs with their name.
8668 @end deffn
8669
8670 @deffn {Command} {pld load} pld_name filename
8671 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{pld_name}.
8672 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8676
8677 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8678 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8679 that particular type of PLD.
8680
8681 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [@option{-no_jstart}]
8682 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8683 This driver can also be used to load Series3, Series6, Series7 and Zynq 7000 devices.
8684 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8685
8686 If @var{-no_jstart} is given, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8687 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8688 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8689
8690 @example
8691 openocd -f board/digilent_zedboard.cfg -c "init" \
8692 -c "pld load 0 zedboard_bitstream.bit"
8693 @end example
8694
8695
8696 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} pld_name
8697 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8698 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8699 @end deffn
8700
8701 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_instr_codes} pld_name cfg_out cfg_in jprogb jstart jshutdown [user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]]
8702 Change values for boundary scan instructions. Default are values for Virtex 2, devices Virtex 4/5/6 and
8703 SSI devices are using different values.
8704 @var{pld_name} is the name of the pld device.
8705 @var{cfg_out} is the value used to select CFG_OUT instruction.
8706 @var{cfg_in} is the value used to select CFG_IN instruction.
8707 @var{jprogb} is the value used to select JPROGRAM instruction.
8708 @var{jstart} is the value used to select JSTART instruction.
8709 @var{jshutdown} is the value used to select JSHUTDOWN instruction.
8710 @var{user1} to @var{user4} are the intruction used to select the user registers USER1 to USER4.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_user_codes} pld_name user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]
8714 Change values for boundary scan instructions selecting the registers USER1 to USER4.
8715 Description of the arguments can be found at command @command{virtex2 set_instr_codes}.
8716 @end deffn
8717
8718 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 program} pld_name
8719 Load the bitstream from external memory for FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. refresh.
8720 @end deffn
8721 @end deffn
8722
8723
8724
8725 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {lattice} [@option{-family} <name>]
8726 The FGPA families ECP2, ECP3, ECP5, Certus and CertusPro by Lattice are supported.
8727 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA or read the status register and read/write the usercode register.
8728
8729 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{ecp2 ecp3 ecp5 certus}. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8730
8731 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_status} pld_name
8732 Reads and displays the status register
8733 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8734 @end deffn
8735
8736 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_user} pld_name
8737 Reads and displays the user register
8738 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8739 @end deffn
8740
8741 @deffn {Command} {lattice write_user} pld_name val
8742 Writes the user register.
8743 for FPGA @var{pld_name} with value @var{val}.
8744 @end deffn
8745
8746 @deffn {Command} {lattice set_preload} pld_name length
8747 Set the length of the register for the preload. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8748 The load command for the FPGA @var{pld_name} will use a length for the preload of @var{length}.
8749 @end deffn
8750 @end deffn
8751
8752
8753 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {efinix} [@option{-family} <name>]
8754 Both families (Trion and Titanium) sold by Efinix are supported as both use the same protocol for In-System Configuration.
8755 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA.
8756 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{trion|titanium}.
8757 @end deffn
8758
8759
8760 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {intel} [@option{-family} <name>]
8761 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into Intel (former Altera) FPGAs.
8762 The families Cyclone III, Cyclone IV, Cyclone V, Cyclone 10, Arria II are supported.
8763 @c Arria V and Arria 10, MAX II, MAX V, MAX10)
8764
8765 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{cycloneiii cycloneiv cyclonev cyclone10 arriaii}.
8766 This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is ambiguous (same ID is used for chips in different families).
8767
8768 As input file format the driver supports a '.rbf' (raw bitstream file) file. The '.rbf' file can be generated
8769 from a '.sof' file with @verb{|quartus_cpf -c blinker.sof blinker.rbf|}
8770
8771 Creates a new PLD device, an FPGA of the Cyclone III family, using the TAP named @verb{|cycloneiii.tap|}:
8772 @example
8773 pld create cycloneiii.pld intel -chain-position cycloneiii.tap -family cycloneiii
8774 @end example
8775
8776 @deffn {Command} {intel set_bscan} pld_name len
8777 Set boundary scan register length of FPGA @var{pld_name} to @var{len}. This is needed because the
8778 length can vary between chips with the same JTAG ID.
8779 @end deffn
8780
8781 @deffn {Command} {intel set_check_pos} pld_name pos
8782 Selects the position @var{pos} in the boundary-scan register. The bit at this
8783 position is checked after loading the bitstream and must be '1', which is the case when no error occurred.
8784 With a value of -1 for @var{pos} the check will be omitted.
8785 @end deffn
8786 @end deffn
8787
8788
8789 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gowin}
8790 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into FPGAs from Gowin.
8791 It is possible to program the SRAM. Programming the flash is not supported.
8792 The files @verb{|.fs|} and @verb{|.bin|} generated by Gowin FPGA Designer are supported.
8793
8794 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_status} pld_name
8795 Reads and displays the status register
8796 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8797 @end deffn
8798
8799 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_user} pld_name
8800 Reads and displays the user register
8801 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8802 @end deffn
8803
8804 @deffn {Command} {gowin reload} pld_name
8805 Load the bitstream from external memory for
8806 FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. refresh.
8807 @end deffn
8808 @end deffn
8809
8810
8811 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gatemate}
8812 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into GateMate FPGAs form CologneChip.
8813 The files @verb{|.bit|} and @verb{|.cfg|} both generated by p_r tool from CologneChip are supported.
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816
8817 @node General Commands
8818 @chapter General Commands
8819 @cindex commands
8820
8821 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8822 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8823 commands are documented elsewhere.
8824
8825 Intent:
8826 @itemize @bullet
8827 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8828 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8829 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8830 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8831
8832 @item @b{From the human}
8833 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8834 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8835
8836 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8837 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8838 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8839
8840 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8841 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8842 port is 6666.
8843 @end itemize
8844
8845
8846 @section Server Commands
8847
8848 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8849 Exits the current telnet session.
8850 @end deffn
8851
8852 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8853 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8854 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8855 Not every command provides helptext.
8856
8857 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8858 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8859 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8860 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8864 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8865 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8866 containing @var{string}.
8867 Not every command provides helptext.
8868 @end deffn
8869
8870 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8871 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8872 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8873 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8874 Useful in connection with script files
8875 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8876 @end deffn
8877
8878 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8879 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8880 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8881 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8882
8883 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8884 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8885
8886 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8887 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8888 @example
8889 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8890 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8891 @end example
8892 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8893 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8894 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8895 will proceed to quit.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @anchor{debuglevel}
8899 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8900 @cindex message level
8901 Display debug level.
8902 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8903 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8904 Level 0 is error messages only;
8905 level 1 adds warnings;
8906 level 2 adds informational messages;
8907 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8908 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8909 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8910 the command line along with the location of that log
8911 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8912 @xref{Running}.
8913 @end deffn
8914
8915 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8916 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8917 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8918 @example
8919 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8920 @end example
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8924 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8925 the default log output channel is stderr.
8926 @end deffn
8927
8928 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8929 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8930 @end deffn
8931
8932 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8933 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8934 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8935 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8936 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8937 @end deffn
8938
8939 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8940 @section Target State handling
8941 @cindex reset
8942 @cindex halt
8943 @cindex target initialization
8944
8945 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8946 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8947 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8948 a current target which is used to perform the
8949 various operations. The current target may be changed
8950 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8951 target which should become current.
8952
8953 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8954 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8955 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8956 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8957 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8958
8959 @emph{With no arguments}:
8960 list all available registers for the current target,
8961 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8962 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8963 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8964 are flagged as such.
8965
8966 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8967 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8968 bypassing any internal cache.
8969
8970 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8971 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8972 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8973 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8974 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8975 relevant module will flush such values.
8976
8977 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8978 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8979
8980 @example
8981 > reg
8982 ===== ARM registers
8983 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8984 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8985 (2) r2 (/32)
8986 ...
8987 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8988 >
8989 @end example
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8993 Set register values of the target.
8994
8995 @itemize
8996 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8997 @end itemize
8998
8999 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
9000 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
9001
9002 @example
9003 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
9004 @end example
9005 @end deffn
9006
9007 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
9008 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
9009 of register names and values.
9010 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
9011 target, bypassing any caching.
9012
9013 @itemize
9014 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
9015 @end itemize
9016
9017 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
9018 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
9019
9020 @example
9021 get_reg @{pc sp@}
9022 @end example
9023 @end deffn
9024
9025 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
9026 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
9027 script.
9028
9029 @itemize
9030 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
9031 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
9032 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
9033 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
9034 @end itemize
9035
9036 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
9037 memory at address 0x20000000:
9038
9039 @example
9040 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
9041 @end example
9042 @end deffn
9043
9044 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
9045 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
9046 script.
9047 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
9048
9049 @itemize
9050 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
9051 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
9052 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
9053 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
9054 @end itemize
9055
9056 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
9057 memory at address 0x20000000:
9058
9059 @example
9060 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
9061 @end example
9062 @end deffn
9063
9064 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
9065 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
9066 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
9067 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
9068 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
9069 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
9070 (and enter debug mode).
9071 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
9072
9073 @quotation Warning
9074 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
9075 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
9076 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
9077 power mode by gating the core clock;
9078 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
9079
9080 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
9081 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
9082 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
9083 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
9084 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
9085 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
9086
9087 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
9088 work with a JTAG debugger.
9089 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
9090 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9091 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
9092 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
9093 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
9094 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
9095 @end quotation
9096
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
9100 Resume the target at its current code position,
9101 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9102 @end deffn
9103
9104 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
9105 Single-step the target at its current code position,
9106 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9107 @end deffn
9108
9109 @anchor{resetcommand}
9110 @deffn {Command} {reset}
9111 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
9112 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
9113 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
9114 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
9115 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
9116 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
9117
9118 The optional parameter specifies what should
9119 happen after the reset.
9120 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
9121 The other options will not work on all systems.
9122 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9123
9124 @itemize @minus
9125 @item @b{run} Let the target run
9126 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
9127 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
9128 @end itemize
9129 @end deffn
9130
9131 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
9132 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
9133 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
9134 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
9135 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
9136 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
9137 state.
9138 @end deffn
9139
9140 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9141 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9142 Set values of reset signals.
9143 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
9144 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
9145 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
9146 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
9147
9148 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9149 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
9150 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9151 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9152 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
9153 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
9154 the signal will not be modified.
9155
9156 @quotation Note
9157 TRST is specially handled.
9158 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9159 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9160 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9161 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9162 instead of the TRST signal.
9163 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9164 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9165 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9166 with handlers for that event.
9167 @end quotation
9168 @end deffn
9169
9170 @anchor{memoryaccess}
9171 @section Memory access commands
9172 @cindex memory access
9173
9174 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
9175 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
9176 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
9177 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
9178
9179 @enumerate
9180 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
9181 to change the current target.
9182 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
9183 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
9184 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
9185 @end enumerate
9186
9187 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
9188 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
9189 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
9190 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
9191 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
9192 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
9193 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
9194 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
9195 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9196 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9197 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9198 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9199 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
9200 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
9201 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
9202 @end deffn
9203
9204 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
9205 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
9206 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
9207 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
9208 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
9209 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
9210 at the specified address @var{addr}.
9211 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9212 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9213 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9214 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9215 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
9216 @end deffn
9217
9218 @anchor{imageaccess}
9219 @section Image loading commands
9220 @cindex image loading
9221 @cindex image dumping
9222
9223 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
9224 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
9225 binary file named @var{filename}.
9226 @end deffn
9227
9228 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
9229 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
9230 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
9231 @end deffn
9232
9233 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
9234 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
9235 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
9236 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
9237 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
9238 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
9239 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
9240 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
9241 separately.
9242 @end deffn
9243
9244 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
9245 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
9246 The file format may optionally be specified
9247 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
9248 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
9249 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
9250 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
9251 @example
9252 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
9253 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
9254 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
9255 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
9256 $address $length
9257 @}
9258 @end example
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
9262 Displays image section sizes and addresses
9263 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
9264 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
9265 The file format may optionally be specified
9266 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9267 @end deffn
9268
9269 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9270 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9271 The file format may optionally be specified
9272 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9273 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
9274 @end deffn
9275
9276 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9277 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9278 The file format may optionally be specified
9279 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9280 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283
9284 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
9285 @cindex breakpoint
9286 @cindex watchpoint
9287
9288 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
9289 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
9290 watchpoints.
9291 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9292
9293 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9294 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9295 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9296 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9297 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9298 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9299
9300 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9301 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9302 @end deffn
9303
9304 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9305 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9306 @end deffn
9307
9308 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
9309 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
9310 @end deffn
9311
9312 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9313 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9314 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9315 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9316 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9317 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9318 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9319 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9320 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9321 @end deffn
9322
9323
9324 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9325
9326 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9327 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9328 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9329 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9330 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9331 running, can be used.
9332 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9333 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9334 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9335
9336 @quotation Note
9337 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9338 @end quotation
9339
9340 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9341 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9342 communication, respectively.
9343
9344 @quotation Note
9345 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9346 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9347 example.
9348 @end quotation
9349
9350 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9351 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9352 of TCP/IP connections.
9353
9354 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9355 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9356 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9357 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9358 @var{size} bytes.
9359 @end deffn
9360
9361 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9362 Start RTT.
9363 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9364 @end deffn
9365
9366 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9367 Stop RTT.
9368 @end deffn
9369
9370 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9371 Display the polling interval.
9372 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9373 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9374 checked for new data.
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9378 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9379 @end deffn
9380
9381 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9382 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9383 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9384 @end deffn
9385
9386 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9387 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9391 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9392 @end deffn
9393
9394 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9395 on the target device.
9396
9397 @example
9398 resume
9399
9400 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9401 rtt start
9402
9403 rtt server start 9090 0
9404 @end example
9405
9406 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9407 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9408 TCP/IP port 9090.
9409
9410
9411 @section Misc Commands
9412
9413 @cindex profiling
9414 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9415 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9416 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9417 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9418 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9419 limit the address range.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn {Command} {version} [git]
9423 Returns a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9424 With option @option{git}, it returns the git version obtained at compile time
9425 through ``git describe''.
9426 @end deffn
9427
9428 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9429 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9430 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9431 @end deffn
9432
9433 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9434 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9435 @end deffn
9436
9437 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9438 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9439 @end deffn
9440
9441 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9442 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9443 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9444 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9445
9446 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9447 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9448 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9449 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9450
9451 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9452 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9453 @cindex tracing
9454 @cindex ETM
9455 @cindex ETB
9456
9457 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9458 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9459 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9460
9461 @itemize
9462 @item
9463 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9464 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9465 supports such an interface.
9466 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9467 and trace port support.)
9468 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9469 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9470 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9471 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9472 in the board-specific configuration file.
9473 @item
9474 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9475 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9476 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9477 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9478 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9479 @end itemize
9480
9481 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9482
9483 @quotation Issues
9484 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9485 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9486
9487 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9488 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9489 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9490 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9491 dummy trace port driver}.
9492
9493 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9494 as well as tracing only during specific states
9495 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9496
9497 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9498 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9499 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9500 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9501 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9502
9503 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9504 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9505 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9506 this original style of JTAG access.
9507 @end quotation
9508
9509 @subsection ETM Configuration
9510 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9511
9512 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9513 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9514 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9515
9516 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9517 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9518 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9519 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9520 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9521 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9522 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9523 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9524 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9525
9526 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9527 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9528 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9529
9530 @quotation Warning
9531 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9532 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9533 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9534 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9535 @end quotation
9536
9537 @quotation Note
9538 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9539 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9540 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9541 what CPU activities are traced.
9542 @end quotation
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9546 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9547 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9548 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9549 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9550 @end deffn
9551
9552 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9553 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9554 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9555 Did trace data overflow?
9556 Was it triggered?
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9560 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9561 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9562 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9563 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9564
9565 @itemize
9566 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9567 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9568 The value is one of
9569 @option{none} (save nothing),
9570 @option{data} (save data),
9571 @option{address} (save addresses),
9572 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9573 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9574 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9575 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9576 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9577 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9578 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9579 trace stream without an image of the code.
9580 @end itemize
9581 @end deffn
9582
9583 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9584 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9585 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9586 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9587 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9588
9589 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9590 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9591 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9592 @end deffn
9593
9594 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9595
9596 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9597 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9598 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9599
9600 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9601 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9602 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9603 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9604 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9605 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9606 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9607
9608 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9609
9610 @itemize
9611 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9612 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9613 for instruction access within that function's body.
9614 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9615 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9616 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9617 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9618 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9619 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9620 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9621 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9622 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9623 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9624 @item @emph{... more}
9625 @end itemize
9626
9627 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9628 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9629
9630 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9631 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9632 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9636 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9637 @end deffn
9638
9639 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9640 Opens an image file.
9641 @end deffn
9642
9643 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9644 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9645 @end deffn
9646
9647 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9648 Starts trace data collection.
9649 @end deffn
9650
9651 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9652 Stops trace data collection.
9653 @end deffn
9654
9655 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9656 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9657
9658 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9659
9660 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9661 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9662 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9663 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9664 any trace data collection.}
9665 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9666 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9667 @end deffn
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9671 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9672 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9673 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9674 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9675 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9676 @end deffn
9677 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9678 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9679 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9680 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9681 trace trigger becomes active.
9682
9683 @itemize
9684 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9685 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9686 afterwards.
9687 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9688 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9689 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9690 what caused that event to happen.
9691 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9692 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9693 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9694 how the event caused trouble.
9695 @end itemize
9696 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9697 @end deffn
9698
9699 @end deffn
9700
9701 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9702 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9703 @cindex CTI
9704
9705 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9706 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9707 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9708 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9709 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9710 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9711
9712 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9713 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9714 @var{apn}.
9715 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9716 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9717 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9718 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9719 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9720 including additional configuration.
9721 @end deffn
9722
9723 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9724 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9725 @end deffn
9726
9727 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9728 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9729 @end deffn
9730
9731 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9732 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9733 @end deffn
9734
9735 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9736 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9737 @end deffn
9738
9739 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9740 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9744 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9745 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9746 @end deffn
9747
9748 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9749 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9750 of the CTI.
9751 @end deffn
9752
9753 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9754 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9755 useful in TCL scripting.
9756 @end deffn
9757
9758 @section Generic ARM
9759 @cindex ARM
9760
9761 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9762 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9763 commands that may be available.
9764
9765 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9766 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9767 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9768 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9769 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9770 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9771 @end deffn
9772
9773 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9774 @cindex disassemble
9775 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9776 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9777 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9778 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9779 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9780 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9781 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9782
9783 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9784 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9785 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9786 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9787 with a handful of exceptions.
9788 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9789 @end deffn
9790
9791 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9792 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9793 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9794 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9795 and using the MCR instruction.
9796 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9797 an ARM register.)
9798 @end deffn
9799
9800 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9801 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9802 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9803 and the MRC instruction.
9804 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9805 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9806 an ARM register.)
9807 @end deffn
9808
9809 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9810 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9811 core mode if necessary.
9812 @end deffn
9813
9814 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9815 @cindex ARM semihosting
9816 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9817
9818 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9819 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9820 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9821 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9822 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9823 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port> [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all}])
9827 @cindex ARM semihosting
9828 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9829
9830 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9831 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9832 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9833
9834 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9835 @end deffn
9836
9837 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9838 @cindex ARM semihosting
9839 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9840
9841 @example
9842 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9843 @end example
9844
9845 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9846 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9847 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9848 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9852 @cindex ARM semihosting
9853 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9854 status.
9855
9856 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9857 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9858 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9859 debugger.
9860 @end deffn
9861
9862 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9863 @cindex ARM semihosting
9864 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9865
9866 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9867 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9868 the value returned by the target.
9869
9870 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9871 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9872 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9873 encountering a break.
9874
9875 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9876 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9877 to the debugger.
9878 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9879 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9880 request or equivalent").
9881
9882 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9883 this option (default: disabled).
9884 @end deffn
9885
9886 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9887 @cindex ARM semihosting
9888 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9889 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9890
9891 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9892 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9893 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9894 command.
9895 @end deffn
9896
9897 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9898 @cindex ARM semihosting
9899 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9900 Use "." for the current directory.
9901 @end deffn
9902
9903 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9904 @cindex ARMv4
9905 @cindex ARMv5
9906
9907 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9908 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9909 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9910 variant.
9911
9912 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9913 @cindex ARM7
9914 @cindex ARM9
9915
9916 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9917 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9918 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9919 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9920
9921 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9922 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9923 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9924 instead of breakpoints.
9925 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9926
9927 This should be
9928 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9929 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9930 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9931 @end deffn
9932
9933 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9934 @cindex DCC
9935 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9936 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9937 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9938
9939 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9940 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9941 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9942 @end deffn
9943
9944 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9945 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9946 that don't check completion of the operation.
9947 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9948
9949 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9950 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9951 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9952 @end deffn
9953
9954 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9955 @cindex ARM9
9956
9957 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9958 integer processors.
9959 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9960
9961 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9962 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9963 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9964 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9965
9966 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9967 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9968 @cindex vector_catch
9969 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9970 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9971 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9972 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9973 to those hardware vectors.
9974
9975 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9976 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9977 vector catch hardware to intercept
9978 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9979 @option{none} of them,
9980 or a list with one or more of the following:
9981 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9982 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9983 @end deffn
9984
9985 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9986 @cindex ARM920T
9987
9988 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9989 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9990 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9991 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9992 and ARM9 commands.
9993
9994 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9995 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9996 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
10000 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10001 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10002 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
10003 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
10004 (Not all registers can be written.)
10005 @end deffn
10006
10007 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
10008 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
10009 @end deffn
10010
10011 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
10012 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
10016 @cindex ARM926ej-s
10017
10018 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
10019 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
10020 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
10021 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10022 and ARM9 commands.
10023
10024 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
10025 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
10026
10027 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
10028 Print information about the caches found.
10029 @end deffn
10030
10031 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
10032 @cindex ARM966E
10033
10034 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
10035 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10036 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
10037 and ARM9 commands.
10038
10039 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
10040 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10041 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10042 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
10043 ARM966E-S TRM.
10044 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
10045 as required for BIST support.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @subsection XScale specific commands
10049 @cindex XScale
10050
10051 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
10052
10053 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
10054 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
10055 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
10056 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
10057 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
10058 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
10059 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
10060
10061 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
10062 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
10063 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
10064 the mini-IC.
10065
10066 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
10067 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
10068 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
10069 code layout in memory:
10070 @example
10071 _vectors:
10072 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10073 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10074 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10075 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10076 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10077 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10078 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10079 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
10080 .org 0x100
10081 .long real_reset_vector
10082 .long real_ui_handler
10083 .long real_swi_handler
10084 .long real_pf_abort
10085 .long real_data_abort
10086 .long 0 /* unused */
10087 .long real_irq_handler
10088 .long real_fiq_handler
10089 @end example
10090
10091 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
10092 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
10093 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
10094 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
10095 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
10096 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
10097 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
10098 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
10099 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
10100 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
10101 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
10102 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
10103 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
10104 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
10105 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
10106 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
10107 software.
10108
10109 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
10110 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
10111 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
10112 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
10113
10114 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
10115 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
10116 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
10117 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
10118 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
10119 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
10120 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
10121 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
10122 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
10123
10124 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
10125 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10126
10127 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
10128 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
10129 @end deffn
10130
10131 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
10132 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
10133 @end deffn
10134
10135 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
10136 Displays information about the CPU caches.
10137 @end deffn
10138
10139 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
10140 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10141 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10142 @end deffn
10143
10144 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
10145 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
10146 @end deffn
10147
10148 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10149 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
10150 @end deffn
10151
10152 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
10153 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
10154 @end deffn
10155
10156 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10157 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
10158 @end deffn
10159
10160 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10161 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
10162 @end deffn
10163
10164 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
10165 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
10166 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
10167 and modifying how it is emptied.
10168 @end deffn
10169
10170 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
10171 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
10172 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
10173 The image @var{type} may be one of
10174 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
10175 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
10176 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
10177 @end deffn
10178
10179 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
10180 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
10181 @cindex vector_catch
10182 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
10183 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
10184
10185 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
10186 @example
10187 0x01 Trap Reset
10188 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
10189 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
10190 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
10191 0x10 Trap Data Abort
10192 0x20 reserved
10193 0x40 Trap IRQ
10194 0x80 Trap FIQ
10195 @end example
10196 @end deffn
10197
10198 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
10199 @cindex vector_table
10200
10201 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
10202 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
10203 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
10204 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
10205 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
10206
10207 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
10208
10209 @end deffn
10210
10211 @section ARMv6 Architecture
10212 @cindex ARMv6
10213
10214 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
10215 @cindex ARM11
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10218 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
10219 which is enabled by default.
10220 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10221 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
10222 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
10223 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
10224 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
10225 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
10226 @end deffn
10227
10228 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10229 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
10230 which is enabled by default.
10231 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10232 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
10233 @end deffn
10234
10235 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10236 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
10237 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
10238 they are disabled by default.
10239 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
10240 @end deffn
10241
10242 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
10243 @cindex vector_catch
10244 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
10245 coprocessor 14 register 7.
10246 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
10247
10248 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10249 for certain hardware events.
10250 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
10251 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
10252 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
10253 @end deffn
10254
10255 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
10256 @cindex ARMv7
10257 @cindex ARMv8
10258
10259 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
10260 @cindex Cortex-A
10261
10262 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
10263 display information about target caches
10264 @end deffn
10265
10266 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10267 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
10268 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
10269 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
10270 Defaults to 'off'.
10271 @end deffn
10272
10273 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
10274 Initialize core debug
10275 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10276 @end deffn
10277
10278 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
10279 Display/set the current SMP mode
10280 @end deffn
10281
10282 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
10283 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
10284 @end deffn
10285
10286 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10287 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10288 @end deffn
10289
10290 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
10291 configure l2x cache
10292 @end deffn
10293
10294 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10295 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10296 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10297 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10298 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10299 @end deffn
10300
10301 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10302 @cindex Cortex-R
10303
10304 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10305 Initialize core debug
10306 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10307 @end deffn
10308
10309 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10310 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10311 @end deffn
10312
10313
10314 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10315 @cindex tracing
10316 @cindex SWO
10317 @cindex SWV
10318 @cindex TPIU
10319
10320 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10321 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10322 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10323 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10324
10325 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10326 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10327 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10328 which causes quite some confusion.
10329 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10330 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10331
10332 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10333 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10334 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10335
10336 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10337 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10338 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10339 @end deffn
10340
10341 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10342 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10343 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10344 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10345
10346 @itemize @bullet
10347 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10348 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10349 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10350 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10351
10352 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10353 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10354 @end itemize
10355 @end deffn
10356
10357 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10358 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10359 @end deffn
10360
10361 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10362 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10363 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10364 at any time after the initialization, too.
10365 @end deffn
10366
10367 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10368 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10369 individually queried, to return its current value.
10370 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10371 @end deffn
10372
10373 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10374 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10375 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10376 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10377
10378 @itemize @bullet
10379 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10380 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10381
10382 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10383 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10384 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10385
10386 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10387 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10388
10389 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10390 protocol used for trace data:
10391 @itemize @minus
10392 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10393 data bits (default);
10394 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10395 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10396 @end itemize
10397
10398 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10399 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10400 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10401 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10402 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10403 of the TPIU.
10404
10405 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10406 the destination of the trace data:
10407 @itemize @minus
10408 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10409 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10410 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10411 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10412 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10413 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10414 each connected client;
10415 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10416 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10417 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10418 @end itemize
10419
10420 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10421 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10422 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10423 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10424
10425 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10426 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10427 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10428 maximum supported rate automatically.
10429
10430 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10431 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10432 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10433
10434 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10435 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10436 default value is @var{0}.
10437 @end itemize
10438 @end deffn
10439
10440 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10441 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10442 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10443 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10444 data.
10445 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10446 after the @command{init}.
10447 @end deffn
10448
10449 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10450 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10451 @end deffn
10452
10453
10454
10455 Example usage:
10456 @enumerate
10457 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10458 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10459 enough to:
10460 @example
10461 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10462 ...
10463 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10464 ...
10465 @end example
10466 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10467 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10468 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10469 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10470 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10471 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10472 @example
10473 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10474 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10475 @end example
10476 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10477 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10478 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10479 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10480 @example
10481 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10482 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10483 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10484 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10485 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10486 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10487 @end example
10488 @end enumerate
10489
10490 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10491 @cindex tracing
10492 @cindex SWO
10493 @cindex SWV
10494 @cindex ITM
10495 @cindex ETM
10496
10497 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10498 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10499 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10500 @end deffn
10501
10502 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10503 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10504 @end deffn
10505
10506 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10507 @cindex Cortex-M
10508
10509 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10510 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10511
10512 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10513 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10514 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10515 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10516 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10517 the step command leaves with the core running.
10518
10519 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10520 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10521 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10522 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10523
10524 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10525 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10526 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10527 does.
10528
10529 Default is @option{auto}.
10530 @end deffn
10531
10532 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10533 @cindex vector_catch
10534 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10535 for certain hardware events.
10536
10537 Parameters request interception of
10538 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10539 @option{none} of them,
10540 or one or more of the following:
10541 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10542 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10543 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10544 @option{irq_err},
10545 @option{state_err},
10546 @option{chk_err}, or
10547 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10548 @option{reset}.
10549 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10550 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10551 are mapped to HardFault.
10552 UsageFault checks for
10553 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10554 must also be explicitly enabled.
10555
10556 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10557 @end deffn
10558
10559 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10560 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10561 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10562
10563 @itemize @minus
10564 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10565 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10566 @end itemize
10567
10568 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10569 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10570 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10571 to manually reset the peripherals.
10572 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10573
10574 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10575 instead.
10576 @end deffn
10577
10578 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10579 @cindex ARMv8-A
10580 @cindex aarch64
10581
10582 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10583 Display information about target caches
10584 @end deffn
10585
10586 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10587 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10588 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10589 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10590 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10591 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10592 @end deffn
10593
10594 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10595 @cindex disassemble
10596 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10597 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10598 @end deffn
10599
10600 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10601 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10602 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10603 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10604 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10605 @end deffn
10606
10607 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10608 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10609 @option{on}.
10610 @end deffn
10611
10612 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10613 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10614 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10615 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10616 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10617 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10618 @end deffn
10619
10620 @deffn {Command} {$target_name pauth} [@option{off}|@option{on}]
10621 Enable or disable pointer authentication features.
10622 When pointer authentication is used on ARM cores, GDB asks GDB servers for an 8-bytes mask to remove signature bits added by pointer authentication.
10623 If this feature is enabled, OpenOCD provides GDB with an 8-bytes mask.
10624 Pointer authentication feature is broken until gdb 12.1, going to be fixed.
10625 Consider using a newer version of gdb if you want to enable pauth feature.
10626 The default configuration is @option{off}.
10627 @end deffn
10628
10629
10630 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10631
10632 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10633 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10634
10635 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10636
10637 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10638 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10639 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10640 @end deffn
10641
10642 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10643 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10644 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10645 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10646 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10647 @end deffn
10648
10649 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10650
10651 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10652 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10653 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10654 @end deffn
10655
10656 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10657
10658 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10659 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10660 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10661 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10662 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10663 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10664 can be collected.
10665
10666 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10667 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10668 tooling.
10669
10670 @quotation Issues
10671 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10672 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10673 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10674 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10675
10676 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10677 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10678 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10679 software operation on the CPU.
10680 @end quotation
10681
10682 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10683 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10684 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10685 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10686 @end deffn
10687
10688 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10689 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10690 @end deffn
10691
10692 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10693 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10694 control is disabled.
10695 @end deffn
10696
10697 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10698 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10699 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10700 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10701
10702 Supported trace formats:
10703 @itemize
10704 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10705 timing to be determined.
10706 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10707 addresses.
10708 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10709 @end itemize
10710 @end deffn
10711
10712 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10713 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10714 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10715 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10716
10717 Supported conditions:
10718 @itemize
10719 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10720 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10721 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10722 instruction matches start data and mask.
10723 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10724 instruction matches start data and mask.
10725 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10726 data and mask.
10727 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10728 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10729 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10730 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10731 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10732 @end itemize
10733 @end deffn
10734
10735 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10736 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10737 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10738 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10739
10740 Supported conditions:
10741 @itemize
10742 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10743 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10744 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10745 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10746 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10747 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10748 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10749 data and mask.
10750 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10751 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10752 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10753 @end itemize
10754 @end deffn
10755
10756 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10757 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10758
10759 Supported triggers:
10760 @itemize
10761 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10762 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10763 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10764 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10765 collection.
10766 @end itemize
10767 @end deffn
10768
10769 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10770
10771 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10772 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10773 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10774 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10775 @end deffn
10776
10777 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10778 Display trace configuration.
10779 @end deffn
10780
10781 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10782 Display trace collection status.
10783 @end deffn
10784
10785 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10786 Start manual trace collection.
10787 @end deffn
10788
10789 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10790 Stop manual trace collection.
10791 @end deffn
10792
10793 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10794 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10795 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10796 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10797 @option{size} options using DMA.
10798 @end deffn
10799
10800 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10801 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10802 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10803 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10804 @option{size} options using DMA.
10805 @end deffn
10806
10807 @section Intel Architecture
10808
10809 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10810 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10811 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10812 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10813 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10814 @itemize
10815 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10816 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10817 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10818 @end itemize
10819
10820 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10821 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10822 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10823
10824 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10825 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10826 @end deffn
10827
10828 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10829 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10830 @end deffn
10831
10832 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10833 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10834 @end deffn
10835
10836 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10837 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10838 @end deffn
10839
10840 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10841 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10842 @end deffn
10843
10844 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10845 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10846 @end deffn
10847
10848 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10849
10850 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10851 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10852
10853 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10854 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10855 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10856 @end deffn
10857 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10858 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10859
10860 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10861
10862 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10863 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10864 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10865 @end deffn
10866
10867 @subsection Registers commands
10868 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10869 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10870 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10871
10872 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10873
10874 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10875 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10876 and "timer" groups.
10877
10878 @emph{example:}
10879 @example
10880 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10881 @end example
10882
10883 @end deffn
10884
10885 @section RISC-V Architecture
10886
10887 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10888 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10889 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10890 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10891 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10892 implement version 0.11.
10893
10894 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10895
10896 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10897 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10898 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10899
10900 @subsection Vector Registers
10901
10902 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10903 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10904 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10905 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10906 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10907 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10908 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10909 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10910 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10911
10912 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10913 follows:
10914
10915 @example
10916 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10917 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10918 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10919 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10920 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10921 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10922 <union id="riscv_vector">
10923 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10924 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10925 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10926 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10927 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10928 </union>
10929 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10930 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10931 ...
10932 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10933 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10934 </feature>
10935 @end example
10936
10937 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10938
10939 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10940 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10941 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10942 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10943 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10944 named @code{csr<n>}.
10945
10946 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10947 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10948 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10949 CSRs.
10950
10951 @example
10952 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10953 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10954
10955 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10956 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10957
10958 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10959 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10960 @end example
10961 @end deffn
10962
10963 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10964 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10965 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10966 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10967 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10968 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10969 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10970 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10971
10972 @example
10973 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10974 # under the name "custom16":
10975 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10976
10977 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10978 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10979 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10980
10981 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10982 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10983 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10984 @end example
10985 @end deffn
10986
10987 @deffn {Command} {riscv info}
10988 Displays some information OpenOCD detected about the target.
10989 @end deffn
10990
10991 @deffn {Command} {riscv reset_delays} [wait]
10992 OpenOCD learns how many Run-Test/Idle cycles are required between scans to avoid
10993 encountering the target being busy. This command resets those learned values
10994 after `wait` scans. It's only useful for testing OpenOCD itself.
10995 @end deffn
10996
10997 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10998 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10999 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
11000 @end deffn
11001
11002 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
11003 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
11004 deasserted.
11005 @end deffn
11006
11007 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
11008 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
11009 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
11010
11011 Available methods are:
11012 @itemize
11013 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
11014 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
11015 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
11016 @end itemize
11017
11018 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
11019 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
11020
11021 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
11022 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
11023 @end deffn
11024
11025 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
11026 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
11027 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
11028 on physical memory.
11029 @end deffn
11030
11031 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
11032 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
11033 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
11034 performed on physical memory.
11035 @end deffn
11036
11037 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
11038 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
11039 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
11040 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
11041 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
11042 race condition problem in your code.
11043
11044 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
11045 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
11046 @end deffn
11047
11048 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
11049 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
11050 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
11051 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
11052 values.
11053
11054 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
11055 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
11056 and DBUS registers, respectively.
11057 @end deffn
11058
11059 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
11060 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
11061 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
11062 @end deffn
11063
11064 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
11065 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11066 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11067 @end deffn
11068
11069 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
11070 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11071 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11072 @end deffn
11073
11074 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
11075 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
11076 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
11077 @end deffn
11078
11079 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
11080
11081 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
11082 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
11083 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
11084 @example
11085 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
11086 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
11087 @end example
11088
11089 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
11090 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
11091 @end deffn
11092
11093 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
11094 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
11095 @end deffn
11096
11097 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
11098
11099 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
11100 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
11101
11102 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
11103 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
11104 @end deffn
11105
11106 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
11107 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
11108 @end deffn
11109
11110 @section ARC Architecture
11111 @cindex ARC
11112
11113 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
11114 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
11115 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
11116 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
11117 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
11118 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
11119 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
11120 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
11121 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
11122 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
11123 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
11124 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
11125 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
11126 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
11127 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
11128
11129
11130 @subsection General ARC commands
11131
11132 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
11133
11134 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
11135 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
11136 arguments:
11137
11138 @itemize @bullet
11139
11140 @item @code{-name} name
11141 @*Name of a register.
11142
11143 @item @code{-num} number
11144 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
11145
11146 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
11147 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
11148
11149 @end itemize
11150
11151 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
11152
11153 @itemize @bullet
11154
11155 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
11156 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
11157 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
11158 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
11159 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
11160 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
11161
11162 @item @code{-core}
11163 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
11164 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
11165 spaces.
11166
11167 @item @code{-bcr}
11168 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
11169 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
11170 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
11171 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
11172 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
11173
11174 @item @code{-type} type_name
11175 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
11176 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
11177
11178 @item @code{-g}
11179 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
11180 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
11181 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
11182 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
11183 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
11184
11185 @end itemize
11186
11187 @end deffn
11188
11189 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
11190 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
11191 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
11192 @end deffn
11193
11194 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
11195 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
11196 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
11197 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
11198 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
11199 startbit endbit}.
11200 @end deffn
11201
11202 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
11203 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
11204 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
11205 @end deffn
11206
11207 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
11208 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
11209 as an argument for a single command invocation.
11210 @end deffn
11211
11212 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
11213
11214 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
11215 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
11216 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11217 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11218
11219 @end deffn
11220
11221 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
11222 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
11223 registers.
11224 @end deffn
11225
11226 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
11227 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
11228 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11229 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11230
11231 @end deffn
11232
11233 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
11234 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
11235 registers.
11236 @end deffn
11237
11238 @section STM8 Architecture
11239 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
11240 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
11241
11242 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
11243 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
11244
11245 @section Xtensa Architecture
11246
11247 Xtensa is a highly-customizable, user-extensible microprocessor and DSP
11248 architecture for complex embedded systems provided by Cadence Design
11249 Systems, Inc. See the
11250 @uref{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip.html, Tensilica IP}
11251 website for additional information and documentation.
11252
11253 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processor implementations which can be customized by
11254 providing a core-specific configuration file which describes every enabled
11255 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
11256 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. OpenOCD also supports SMP
11257 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows configuring
11258 their debug interconnect (termed "break/stall networks"), which control how debug
11259 signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
11260 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). OpenOCD implements both generic Xtensa targets
11261 as well as several Espressif Xtensa-based chips from the
11262 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
11263
11264 OCD sessions for Xtensa processor and DSP targets are accessed via the Xtensa
11265 Debug Module (XDM), which provides external connectivity either through a
11266 traditional JTAG interface or an ARM DAP interface. If used, the DAP interface
11267 can control Xtensa targets through JTAG or SWD probes.
11268
11269 @subsection Xtensa Core Configuration
11270
11271 Due to the high level of configurability in Xtensa cores, the Xtensa target
11272 configuration comprises two categories:
11273
11274 @enumerate
11275 @item Base Xtensa support common to all core configurations, and
11276 @item Core-specific support as configured for individual cores.
11277 @end enumerate
11278
11279 All common Xtensa support is built into the OpenOCD Xtensa target layer and
11280 is enabled through a combination of TCL scripts: the target-specific
11281 @file{target/xtensa.cfg} and a board-specific @file{board/xtensa-*.cfg},
11282 similar to other target architectures.
11283
11284 Importantly, core-specific configuration information must be provided by
11285 the user, and takes the form of an @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} TCL script that
11286 defines the core's configurable features through a series of Xtensa
11287 configuration commands (detailed below).
11288
11289 This core-specific @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} file is typically either:
11290
11291 @itemize @bullet
11292 @item Located within the Xtensa core configuration build as
11293 @file{src/config/xtensa-core-openocd.cfg}, or
11294 @item Generated by running the command @code{xt-gdb --dump-oocd-config}
11295 from the Xtensa processor tool-chain's command-line tools.
11296 @end itemize
11297
11298 NOTE: @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} must match the target Xtensa hardware
11299 connected to OpenOCD.
11300
11301 Some example Xtensa configurations are bundled with OpenOCD for reference:
11302 @itemize @bullet
11303 @item Cadence Palladium VDebug emulation target. The user can combine their
11304 @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} with the provided
11305 @file{board/xtensa-palladium-vdebug.cfg} to debug an emulated Xtensa RTL design.
11306 @item NXP MIMXRT685-EVK evaluation kit. The relevant configuration files are
11307 @file{board/xtensa-rt685-jlink.cfg} and @file{board/xtensa-core-nxp_rt600.cfg}.
11308 Additional information is provided by
11309 @uref{https://www.nxp.com/design/development-boards/i-mx-evaluation-and-development-boards/i-mx-rt600-evaluation-kit:MIMXRT685-EVK,
11310 NXP}.
11311 @end itemize
11312
11313 @subsection Xtensa Configuration Commands
11314
11315 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtdef} (@option{LX}|@option{NX})
11316 Configure the Xtensa target architecture. Currently, Xtensa support is limited
11317 to LX6, LX7, and NX cores.
11318 @end deffn
11319
11320 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtopt} option value
11321 Configure Xtensa target options that are relevant to the debug subsystem.
11322 @var{option} is one of: @option{arnum}, @option{windowed},
11323 @option{cpenable}, @option{exceptions}, @option{intnum}, @option{hipriints},
11324 @option{excmlevel}, @option{intlevels}, @option{debuglevel},
11325 @option{ibreaknum}, or @option{dbreaknum}. @var{value} is an integer with
11326 the exact range determined by each particular option.
11327
11328 NOTE: Some options are specific to Xtensa LX or Xtensa NX architecture, while
11329 others may be common to both but have different valid ranges.
11330 @end deffn
11331
11332 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{iram}|@option{dram}|@option{sram}|@option{irom}|@option{drom}|@option{srom}) baseaddr bytes
11333 Configure Xtensa target memory. Memory type determines access rights,
11334 where RAMs are read/write while ROMs are read-only. @var{baseaddr} and
11335 @var{bytes} are both integers, typically hexadecimal and decimal, respectively.
11336 @end deffn
11337
11338 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{icache}|@option{dcache}) linebytes cachebytes ways [writeback]
11339 Configure Xtensa processor cache. All parameters are required except for
11340 the optional @option{writeback} parameter; all are integers.
11341 @end deffn
11342
11343 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmpu} numfgseg minsegsz lockable execonly
11344 Configure an Xtensa Memory Protection Unit (MPU). MPUs can restrict access
11345 and/or control cacheability of specific address ranges, but are lighter-weight
11346 than a full traditional MMU. All parameters are required; all are integers.
11347 @end deffn
11348
11349 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmmu} numirefillentries numdrefillentries
11350 (Xtensa-LX only) Configure an Xtensa Memory Management Unit (MMU). Both
11351 parameters are required; both are integers.
11352 @end deffn
11353
11354 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregs} numregs
11355 Configure the total number of registers for the Xtensa core. Configuration
11356 logic expects to subsequently process this number of @code{xtensa xtreg}
11357 definitions. @var{numregs} is an integer.
11358 @end deffn
11359
11360 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregfmt} (@option{sparse}|@option{contiguous}) [general]
11361 Configure the type of register map used by GDB to access the Xtensa core.
11362 Generic Xtensa tools (e.g. xt-gdb) require @option{sparse} mapping (default) while
11363 Espressif tools expect @option{contiguous} mapping. Contiguous mapping takes an
11364 additional, optional integer parameter @option{numgregs}, which specifies the number
11365 of general registers used in handling g/G packets.
11366 @end deffn
11367
11368 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtreg} name offset
11369 Configure an Xtensa core register. All core registers are 32 bits wide,
11370 while TIE and user registers may have variable widths. @var{name} is a
11371 character string identifier while @var{offset} is a hexadecimal integer.
11372 @end deffn
11373
11374 @subsection Xtensa Operation Commands
11375
11376 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (@option{on}|@option{off})
11377 (Xtensa-LX only) Mask or unmask Xtensa interrupts during instruction step.
11378 When masked, an interrupt that occurs during a step operation is handled and
11379 its ISR is executed, with the user's debug session returning after potentially
11380 executing many instructions. When unmasked, a triggered interrupt will result
11381 in execution progressing the requested number of instructions into the relevant
11382 vector/ISR code.
11383 @end deffn
11384
11385 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
11386 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
11387 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
11388 @end deffn
11389
11390 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
11391 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
11392 @itemize @bullet
11393 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
11394 signal from other cores.
11395 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
11396 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
11397 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11398 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11399 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11400 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11401 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11402 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11403 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11404 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11405 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11406 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11407 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11408 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11409 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11410 @end itemize
11411 @end deffn
11412
11413 @deffn {Command} {xtensa exe} <ascii-encoded hexadecimal instruction bytes>
11414 Execute arbitrary instruction(s) provided as an ascii string. The string represents an integer
11415 number of instruction bytes, thus its length must be even.
11416 @end deffn
11417
11418 @subsection Xtensa Performance Monitor Configuration
11419
11420 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11421 Enable and start performance counter.
11422 @itemize @bullet
11423 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11424 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11425 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11426 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11427 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11428 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11429 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11430 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11431 whether to count.
11432 @end itemize
11433 @end deffn
11434
11435 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11436 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11437 @end deffn
11438
11439 @subsection Xtensa Trace Configuration
11440
11441 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11442 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11443 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11444 @itemize @bullet
11445 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11446 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11447 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11448 @end itemize
11449 @end deffn
11450
11451 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11452 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11453 @end deffn
11454
11455 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11456 Dump trace memory to a file.
11457 @end deffn
11458
11459 @section Espressif Specific Commands
11460
11461 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (start <destination> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11462 Starts
11463 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11464 Data will be stored to specified destination. Available destinations are:
11465 @itemize @bullet
11466 @item @code{file://<outfile>} - Save trace logs into file.
11467 @item @code{tcp://<host>:<port>} - Send trace logs to tcp port on specified host. OpenOCD will act as a tcp client.
11468 @item @code{con:} - Print trace logs to the stdout.
11469 @end itemize
11470 Other parameters will be same for each destination.
11471 @itemize @bullet
11472 @item @code{poll_period} - trace data polling period in ms.
11473 @item @code{trace_size} - maximum trace data size.
11474 Tracing will be stopped automatically when that amount is reached.
11475 Use "-1" to disable the limitation.
11476 @item @code{stop_tmo} - Data reception timeout in ms.
11477 Tracing will be stopped automatically when no data is received within that period.
11478 @item @code{wait4halt} - if non-zero then wait for target to be halted before tracing start.
11479 @item @code{skip_size} - amount of tracing data to be skipped before writing it to destination.
11480 @end itemize
11481 @end deffn
11482
11483 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (stop)
11484 Stops tracing started with above command.
11485 @end deffn
11486
11487 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (status)
11488 Requests ongoing tracing status.
11489 @end deffn
11490
11491 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (dump file://<outfile>)
11492 Dumps tracing data from target buffer. It can be useful to dump the latest data
11493 buffered on target for post-mortem analysis. For example when target starts tracing automatically
11494 w/o OpenOCD command and keeps only the latest data window which fit into the buffer.
11495 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11496 Data will be stored to specified destination.
11497 @end deffn
11498
11499 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (start file://<outfile1> [file://<outfile2>] [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11500 Starts @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView}
11501 compatible tracing. Data will be stored to specified destination.
11502 For dual-core chips traces from every core will be saved to separate files.
11503 Resulting files can be open in "SEGGER SystemView" application.
11504 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11505 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp apptrace start}.
11506 @end deffn
11507
11508 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (stop)
11509 Stops SystremView compatible tracing started with above command.
11510 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11511 @end deffn
11512
11513 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (status)
11514 Requests ongoing SystremView compatible tracing status.
11515 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11516 @end deffn
11517
11518 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (start file://<outfile> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11519 This command is identical to @command{esp sysview start}, but uses Espressif multi-core extension to
11520 @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView} data format.
11521 Data will be stored to specified destination. Tracing data from all cores are saved in the same file.
11522 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp sysview start}.
11523 @end deffn
11524
11525 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (stop)
11526 Stops Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing started with above command.
11527 @end deffn
11528
11529 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (status)
11530 Requests ongoing Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing status.
11531 @end deffn
11532
11533 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11534 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11535 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11536 @cindex tracing
11537 @cindex libdcc
11538 @cindex DCC
11539 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11540 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11541 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11542 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11543
11544 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11545 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11546 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11547 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11548 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11549 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11550
11551 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11552 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11553 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11554 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11555 The target being debugged may
11556 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11557 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11558 each supported by a command:
11559
11560 @itemize
11561 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11562 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11563 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11564 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11565
11566 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11567 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11568 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11569
11570 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11571 and then displayed at any time.
11572 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11573
11574 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11575 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11576 @end itemize
11577
11578 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11579 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11580 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11581 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11582 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11583 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11584 does the same thing.
11585
11586 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11587 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11588 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11589 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11590 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11591
11592 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11593 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11594 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11595 @end deffn
11596
11597 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11598 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11599 in the order they triggered.
11600 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11601 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11602 history records.
11603 @end deffn
11604
11605 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11606 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11607 they have been triggered.
11608 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11609 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11610 and associates it with that identifier.
11611
11612 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11613 are not related except by this command.
11614 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11615 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11616 @end deffn
11617
11618
11619 @node JTAG Commands
11620 @chapter JTAG Commands
11621 @cindex JTAG Commands
11622 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11623 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11624 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11625 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11626 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11627
11628 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11629 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11630
11631 @itemize @bullet
11632 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11633 devices such as a CPUs.
11634 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11635 standard state machine (in parallel)
11636 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11637 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11638 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11639 while the reading previous ones.
11640 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11641 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11642 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11643 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11644 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11645 registers.
11646 @end itemize
11647
11648 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11649
11650 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11651 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11652 the order of TAP state transitions.
11653 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11654 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11655 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11656 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11657 these commands are not available.
11658
11659 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11660 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11661 that specify the entire register.
11662 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11663 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11664 The return value holds the original value of each
11665 of those fields.
11666
11667 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11668 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11669 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11670 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11671 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11672
11673 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11674 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11675
11676 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11677 in that state.
11678 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11679 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11680 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11681
11682 @quotation Warning
11683 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11684 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11685 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11686 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11687 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11688 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11689 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11690 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11691 @end quotation
11692 @end deffn
11693
11694 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11695 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11696 This may be used for performance tuning.
11697
11698 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11699 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11700 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11701 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11702 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11703 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11704 @end deffn
11705
11706 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11707 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11708 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11709 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11710 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11711 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11712
11713 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11714 in that state.
11715 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11716 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11717 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11718
11719 @quotation Note
11720 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11721 register values, unlike data register values.
11722 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11723 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11724 @end quotation
11725 @end deffn
11726
11727 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11728 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11729 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11730 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11731 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11732 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11733 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11734 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11735 The final state must also be stable.
11736 @end deffn
11737
11738 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11739 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11740 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11741 Instructions often need some time
11742 to execute before they take effect.
11743 @end deffn
11744
11745 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11746 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11747
11748 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11749 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11750 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11751 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11752 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11753 @end deffn
11754
11755 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11756 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11757 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11758 must also be enabled.
11759 Default is enabled.
11760 @end deffn
11761
11762 @section TAP state names
11763 @cindex TAP state names
11764
11765 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11766 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11767 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11768 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11769
11770 @itemize @bullet
11771 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11772 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11773 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11774 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11775 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11776 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11777 through the data register
11778 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11779 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11780 for update or more shifting
11781 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11782 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11783 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11784 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11785 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11786 through the instruction register
11787 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11788 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11789 for update or more shifting
11790 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11791 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11792 @end itemize
11793
11794 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11795 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11796 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11797 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11798
11799 @itemize @bullet
11800 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11801 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11802 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11803 may not be as expected.
11804 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11805 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11806 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11807 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11808 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11809 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11810 @end itemize
11811
11812 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11813 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11814
11815 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11816 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11817 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11818 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11819
11820 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11821 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11822 @cindex SVF
11823
11824 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11825 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11826 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11827 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11828
11829 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{-quiet}] @
11830 [@option{-nil}] [@option{-progress}] [@option{-ignore_error}] @
11831 [@option{-noreset}] [@option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}}]
11832 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11833 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11834
11835 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11836 affect their semantics.
11837
11838 Command options:
11839 @itemize @minus
11840 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11841 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11842 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11843 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11844 @item @option{-quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11845 @item @option{-nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11846 on the real interface;
11847 @item @option{-progress} enable progress indication;
11848 @item @option{-ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11849 errors.
11850 @item @option{-noreset} omit JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) before executing
11851 content of the SVF file;
11852 @item @option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}} inject @var{cyclecount} number of
11853 additional TCLK cycles after each SDR scan instruction;
11854 @end itemize
11855 @end deffn
11856
11857 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11858 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11859 @cindex XSVF
11860
11861 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11862 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11863 Xilinx devices.
11864 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11865 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11866
11867 @quotation Important
11868 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11869 @end quotation
11870
11871 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11872 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11873 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11874 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11875 that TAP.
11876 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11877 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11878 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11879 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11880 @end deffn
11881
11882 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11883 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11884 after building the software.
11885 You may find them useful:
11886
11887 @itemize
11888 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11889 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11890 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11891 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11892 @end itemize
11893
11894 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11895 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11896 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11897 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11898 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11899 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11900 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11901
11902
11903 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11904 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11905 @cindex IPDBG
11906
11907 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11908 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11909 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11910 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11911 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11912 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11913
11914 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}] [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}]
11915 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11916
11917 Command options:
11918 @itemize @bullet
11919 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11920 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11921 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11922 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11923 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host will listen. The default is 4242 which is used when the option is not given.
11924 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub. The default is 1 which is used when the option is not given.
11925 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is reachable if there is a
11926 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11927 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11928 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11929 shift data through vir can be configured.
11930 @end itemize
11931 @end deffn
11932 or
11933 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-pld @var{name} [@var{user}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}]
11934 Also starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. The pld drivers are able to provide the tap and hub/IR for the IPDBG JTAG-Host server.
11935 With the @option{-pld @var{name} [@var{user}]} the information from the pld-driver is used and the options @option{-tap} and @option{-hub} are not required.
11936 The defined driver for the pld @var{name} gets selected. (The pld devices names can be shown by the command @command{pld devices}).
11937
11938 The @verb{|USERx|} instructions are vendor specific and don't change between families of the same vendor.
11939 So if there's a pld driver for your vendor it should work with your FPGA even when the driver is not compatible with your device for the remaining features. If your device/vendor is not supported you have to use the previous command.
11940
11941 With [@var{user}] one can select a different @verb{|USERx|}-Instruction. If the IPDBG JTAG-Hub is used without modification the default value of 1 which selects the first @verb{|USERx|} instruction is adequate.
11942
11943 The remaining options are described in the previous command.
11944 @end deffn
11945
11946 Examples:
11947 @example
11948 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11949 @end example
11950 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11951 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11952
11953 @example
11954 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11955 @end example
11956 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11957 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11958
11959 @example
11960 ipdbg -start -pld xc7.pld -port 5555 -tool 0
11961 @end example
11962 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 5555 which connects to tool 0 (data_up_0/data_down_0).
11963 The TAP and ir value used to reach the JTAG Hub is given by the pld driver.
11964
11965
11966 @node Utility Commands
11967 @chapter Utility Commands
11968 @cindex Utility Commands
11969
11970 @section RAM testing
11971 @cindex RAM testing
11972
11973 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11974 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11975 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11976 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11977 hardware problems.
11978
11979 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11980 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11981 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11982 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11983
11984 Load the memory testing functions with
11985
11986 @example
11987 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11988 @end example
11989
11990 to get access to the following facilities:
11991
11992 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11993 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11994 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11995 @end deffn
11996
11997 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11998 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11999 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
12000 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
12001 @end deffn
12002
12003 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
12004 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
12005 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
12006 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
12007 @end deffn
12008
12009 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
12010 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
12011 @end deffn
12012
12013 @section Firmware recovery helpers
12014 @cindex Firmware recovery
12015
12016 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
12017 devices recovery with JTAG.
12018
12019 For quickstart instructions run:
12020 @example
12021 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
12022 @end example
12023
12024 @node GDB and OpenOCD
12025 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
12026 @cindex GDB
12027 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
12028 to debug remote targets.
12029 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
12030
12031 @itemize
12032 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
12033 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
12034 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
12035 as shown in this chapter.
12036 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
12037 that also will probably need to be configured.
12038 @end itemize
12039
12040 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
12041 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
12042 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
12043 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
12044 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
12045 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
12046
12047 @section Connecting to GDB
12048 @cindex Connecting to GDB
12049 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
12050 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
12051 errors, which has since been fixed; see
12052 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
12053
12054 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
12055
12056 @enumerate
12057 @item
12058 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
12059 @example
12060 target extended-remote localhost:3333
12061 @end example
12062 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
12063
12064 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
12065 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
12066 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
12067
12068 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
12069 remote command above that becomes:
12070 @example
12071 tar ext :3333
12072 @end example
12073
12074 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
12075 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
12076 available through the command:
12077 @example
12078 target remote localhost:3333
12079 @end example
12080
12081 @item
12082 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
12083 @example
12084 target extended-remote | \
12085 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
12086 @end example
12087 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
12088 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
12089 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
12090 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
12091 @end enumerate
12092
12093 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
12094 GDB command line.
12095
12096 @section Sample GDB session startup
12097
12098 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
12099 than they do when you're debugging locally.
12100 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
12101 small ARM program.
12102 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
12103 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
12104
12105 @example
12106 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
12107 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
12108 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
12109 ...
12110 (gdb) monitor reset halt
12111 ...
12112 (gdb) load
12113 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
12114 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
12115 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
12116 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
12117 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
12118 (gdb) continue
12119 Continuing.
12120 ...
12121 @end example
12122
12123 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
12124 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
12125 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
12126 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
12127
12128 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
12129
12130 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
12131 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
12132 packet size and the device's memory map.
12133 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
12134 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
12135 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
12136
12137 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
12138 You may need to set those up by hand.
12139 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
12140 something like:
12141
12142 @example
12143 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
12144 @end example
12145
12146 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
12147
12148 @example
12149 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
12150 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
12151 @end example
12152
12153 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
12154 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
12155 do not have such restrictions.
12156
12157 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
12158 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
12159 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
12160 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
12161
12162 @section Programming using GDB
12163 @cindex Programming using GDB
12164 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
12165
12166 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
12167 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
12168 @example
12169 gdb_memory_map disable
12170 @end example
12171 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
12172 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
12173 working area.
12174
12175 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
12176 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
12177 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
12178 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
12179
12180 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
12181 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
12182
12183 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
12184 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
12185 @example
12186 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
12187 @end example
12188
12189 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
12190 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
12191
12192 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
12193 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
12194 will be used.
12195
12196 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
12197 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
12198 @example
12199 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
12200 @end example
12201 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
12202
12203 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
12204 can be used.
12205
12206 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12207 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12208 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
12209
12210 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
12211 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
12212 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
12213
12214 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
12215 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
12216 and GDB treats it as it were running.
12217 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
12218 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
12219 without any intrusion of the target process.
12220
12221 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
12222 Place following command after target configuration:
12223 @example
12224 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
12225 @end example
12226
12227 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
12228 switch off gdb_memory_map:
12229 @example
12230 gdb_memory_map disable
12231 @end example
12232
12233 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
12234 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
12235 @example
12236 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
12237 @end example
12238
12239 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
12240 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
12241
12242 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
12243 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
12244 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
12245 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
12246
12247 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
12248 previously shown variables.
12249
12250 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
12251 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
12252 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
12253 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
12254 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
12255
12256 @section RTOS Support
12257 @cindex RTOS Support
12258 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
12259
12260 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
12261 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
12262
12263 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
12264 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
12265 GDB commands.
12266
12267 @* An example setup is below:
12268
12269 @example
12270 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
12271 @end example
12272
12273 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
12274
12275 Currently supported rtos's include:
12276 @itemize @bullet
12277 @item @option{eCos}
12278 @item @option{ThreadX}
12279 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
12280 @item @option{linux}
12281 @item @option{ChibiOS}
12282 @item @option{embKernel}
12283 @item @option{mqx}
12284 @item @option{uCOS-III}
12285 @item @option{nuttx}
12286 @item @option{RIOT}
12287 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
12288 @item @option{Zephyr}
12289 @item @option{rtkernel}
12290 @end itemize
12291
12292 At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
12293 @example
12294 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
12295 @end example
12296
12297 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
12298 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
12299
12300 @table @code
12301 @item eCos symbols
12302 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
12303 @item ThreadX symbols
12304 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
12305 @item FreeRTOS symbols
12306 @raggedright
12307 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
12308 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
12309 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority, xSchedulerRunning.
12310 @end raggedright
12311 @item linux symbols
12312 init_task.
12313 @item ChibiOS symbols
12314 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
12315 @item embKernel symbols
12316 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
12317 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
12318 @item mqx symbols
12319 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
12320 @item uC/OS-III symbols
12321 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
12322 @item nuttx symbols
12323 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
12324 @item RIOT symbols
12325 @raggedright
12326 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
12327 _tcb_name_offset.
12328 @end raggedright
12329 @item Zephyr symbols
12330 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
12331 @item rtkernel symbols
12332 Multiple struct offsets.
12333 @end table
12334
12335 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
12336 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
12337
12338 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
12339 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
12340
12341 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
12342 along with the project:
12343
12344 @table @code
12345 @item FreeRTOS
12346 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
12347 @item uC/OS-III
12348 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
12349 @end table
12350
12351 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
12352 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
12353 @cindex SMP
12354 @cindex RTOS
12355 @cindex hwthread
12356 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
12357 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
12358 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
12359 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
12360 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
12361 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
12362 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
12363 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
12364 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
12365
12366 @node Tcl Scripting API
12367 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
12368 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
12369 @cindex Tcl scripts
12370 @section API rules
12371
12372 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
12373 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
12374 of state information as an argument to each proc.
12375
12376 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
12377 pair list and lists.
12378
12379 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
12380 list.
12381
12382 @example
12383 > set foo(me) Duane
12384 > set foo(you) Oyvind
12385 > set foo(mouse) Micky
12386 > set foo(duck) Donald
12387 @end example
12388
12389 If one does this:
12390
12391 @example
12392 > set foo
12393 @end example
12394
12395 The result is:
12396
12397 @example
12398 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
12399 @end example
12400
12401 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
12402
12403 @verbatim
12404 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
12405 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
12406 }
12407 @end verbatim
12408
12409 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
12410 should be passed in to the proc in question.
12411
12412 @section Internal low-level Commands
12413
12414 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
12415 invoke directly.
12416
12417 @itemize
12418 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
12419
12420 Return information about the flash banks
12421
12422 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
12423
12424 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
12425 its execution. Example:
12426
12427 @example
12428 > capture "reset init"
12429 @end example
12430
12431 @end itemize
12432
12433 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
12434 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
12435 called "flash_banks".
12436
12437 @section Tcl RPC server
12438 @cindex RPC
12439
12440 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
12441 commands and receive the results.
12442
12443 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
12444 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
12445 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
12446 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
12447 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
12448
12449 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
12450 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
12451 @command{capture} command.
12452
12453 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
12454
12455 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
12456 @cindex RPC Notifications
12457
12458 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12459 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12460
12461 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
12462 in the following format.
12463
12464 @verbatim
12465 type target_event event [event-name]
12466 type target_state state [state-name]
12467 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
12468 @end verbatim
12469
12470 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
12471 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
12472 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12473 Defaults to off.
12474
12475 @end deffn
12476
12477 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
12478 @cindex RPC trace output
12479
12480 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12481 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12482
12483 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
12484
12485 @verbatim
12486 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
12487 @end verbatim
12488
12489 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
12490 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
12491 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12492 Defaults to off.
12493
12494 See an example application here:
12495 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
12496
12497 @end deffn
12498
12499 @node FAQ
12500 @chapter FAQ
12501 @cindex faq
12502 @enumerate
12503 @anchor{faqrtck}
12504 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
12505 @cindex RTCK
12506 @cindex adaptive clocking
12507 @*
12508
12509 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
12510 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
12511 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
12512 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
12513
12514 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12515 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12516 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12517 @enumerate
12518 @item
12519 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12520 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12521 @item
12522 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12523 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12524 @end enumerate
12525
12526 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12527 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12528 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12529 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12530 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12531 power).
12532
12533 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12534 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12535 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12536 ARM926 scenario).
12537 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12538 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12539 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12540
12541 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12542 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12543 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12544 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12545
12546 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12547
12548 In order to make use of this,
12549 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12550 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12551
12552 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12553 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12554 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12555 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12556 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12557
12558 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12559 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12560 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12561 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12562
12563 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12564 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12565 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12566 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12567 with a CPLD.
12568 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12569 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12570 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12571 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12572 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12573 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12574
12575 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12576
12577 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12578
12579 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12580 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12581 depending on the chips on your board.
12582 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12583 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12584 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12585
12586 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12587 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12588 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12589
12590 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12591 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12592 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12593 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12594
12595 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12596 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12597 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12598 this way.
12599
12600 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12601 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12602 clock rate.
12603 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12604 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12605 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12606
12607 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12608
12609 @example
12610 # Example: 1.234MHz
12611 adapter speed 1234
12612 @end example
12613
12614
12615 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12616
12617 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12618 around Windows filenames.
12619
12620 @example
12621 > echo \a
12622
12623 > echo @{\a@}
12624 \a
12625 > echo "\a"
12626
12627 >
12628 @end example
12629
12630
12631 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12632
12633 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12634 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12635 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12636
12637 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12638 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12639 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12640
12641 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12642 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12643 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12644
12645 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12646
12647 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12648 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12649 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12650 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12651
12652 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12653 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12654 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12655
12656 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12657 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12658
12659 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12660 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12661 memory read caused data abort".
12662
12663 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12664 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12665 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12666 be done, feel free to add this here.
12667
12668 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12669 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12670 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12671 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12672 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12673 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12674 gracefully stops.
12675
12676 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12677 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12678 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12679
12680 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12681 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12682 bytes. Painful...
12683
12684
12685 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12686 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12687
12688 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12689 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12690 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12691 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12692 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12693 reset, everything else should work fine.
12694
12695 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12696 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12697 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12698 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12699
12700 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12701 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12702 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12703 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12704
12705 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12706
12707 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12708 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12709 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12710
12711 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12712 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12713
12714 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12715 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12716 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12717 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12718 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12719 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12720 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12721 clock frequency?
12722
12723 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12724 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12725 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12726 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12727 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12728
12729 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12730
12731 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12732 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12733 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12734 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12735 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12736 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12737 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12738
12739 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12740
12741 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12742 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12743 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12744 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12745
12746 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12747 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12748 particular order?
12749
12750 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12751 the same order used by the hardware.
12752
12753 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12754 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12755 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12756 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12757 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12758 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12759
12760 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12761 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12762 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12763 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12764
12765 @itemize @bullet
12766 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12767 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12768 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12769 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12770 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12771 @end itemize
12772
12773 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12774
12775 @itemize @bullet
12776 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12777 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12778 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12779 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12780 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12781 @end itemize
12782
12783
12784 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12785 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12786 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12787
12788 TODO.
12789
12790 @end enumerate
12791
12792 @node Tcl Crash Course
12793 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12794 @cindex Tcl
12795
12796 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12797 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12798 how the Tcl scripts work.
12799
12800 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12801 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12802 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12803 OpenOCD.
12804
12805 @section Tcl Rule #1
12806 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12807 @enumerate
12808 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12809 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12810 @end enumerate
12811
12812 The Tcl equal is this:
12813
12814 @enumerate
12815 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12816 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12817 @end enumerate
12818
12819 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12820 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12821
12822 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12823 There is a second pair of rules.
12824 @enumerate
12825 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12826 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12827 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12828 in Tcl.
12829 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12830 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12831 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12832 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12833 @end enumerate
12834
12835 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12836 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12837 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12838 Everything is a string}
12839
12840 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12841 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12842 difference is subtle.
12843 @enumerate
12844 @item Parse Time
12845 @item Evaluation Time
12846 @end enumerate
12847
12848 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12849 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12850 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12851
12852 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12853 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12854 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12855 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12856
12857 @itemize @bullet
12858 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12859 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12860 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12861 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12862 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12863 @example
12864 # bash example
12865 X=`date`
12866 echo "The Date is: $X"
12867 # Tcl example
12868 set X [date]
12869 puts "The Date is: $X"
12870 @end example
12871 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12872 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12873 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12874 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12875 is a string}
12876 @example
12877 set x "Dinner"
12878 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12879 @end example
12880 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12881 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12882 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12883 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12884 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12885 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12886 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12887 @end itemize
12888
12889 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12890
12891 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12892
12893 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12894
12895 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12896 the normal way.
12897
12898 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12899 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12900 line is immediately executed.
12901
12902 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12903 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12904
12905 @subsection Command Execution
12906
12907 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12908 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12909 control flow operators.
12910
12911 Commands are executed like this:
12912
12913 @enumerate
12914 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12915 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12916 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12917 @end enumerate
12918
12919 It sort of works like this:
12920 @example
12921 for(;;)@{
12922 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12923
12924 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12925
12926 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12927 @}
12928 @end example
12929
12930 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12931 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12932 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12933 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12934 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12935 ``LookupCommand()''
12936
12937 @subsection The FOR command
12938
12939 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12940 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12941 command just like any other command.
12942
12943 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12944 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12945 are:
12946
12947 @enumerate 0
12948 @item The ascii text 'for'
12949 @item The start text
12950 @item The test expression
12951 @item The next text
12952 @item The body text
12953 @end enumerate
12954
12955 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12956 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12957 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12958 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12959
12960 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12961 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12962
12963 @example
12964 int
12965 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12966 int *argc,
12967 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12968 @end example
12969
12970 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12971 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12972 still operates in the same basic way.
12973
12974 @subsection FOR command implementation
12975
12976 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12977 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12978
12979 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12980
12981 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12982
12983 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12984 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12985 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12986
12987 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12988 expression and returns a value.
12989
12990 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12991 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12992 @example
12993 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12994
12995 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12996
12997 int
12998 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12999 int argc,
13000 char **argv )
13001 @{
13002 if( argc != 5 )@{
13003 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
13004 return ERROR;
13005 @}
13006
13007 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
13008
13009 // Execute the start statement.
13010 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
13011
13012 // Top of loop test
13013 for(;;)@{
13014 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
13015 if( i == 0 )
13016 break;
13017
13018 // Execute the body
13019 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
13020
13021 // Execute the LOOP part
13022 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
13023 @}
13024
13025 // Return no error
13026 SetResult( interp, "" );
13027 return SUCCESS;
13028 @}
13029 @end example
13030
13031 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
13032 in the same basic way.
13033
13034 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
13035
13036 @subsection source and find commands
13037 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
13038 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
13039 @*Remember the parsing rules
13040 @enumerate
13041 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
13042 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
13043 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
13044 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
13045 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
13046 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
13047 That character begins Tcl comments.)
13048 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
13049 it reads a file and executes as a script.
13050 @end enumerate
13051 @subsection format command
13052 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
13053 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
13054 @b{sprintf()}.
13055 @b{Example}
13056 @example
13057 set x 6
13058 set y 7
13059 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
13060 @end example
13061 @enumerate
13062 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
13063 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
13064 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
13065 @* Refer to Rule #1
13066 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
13067 @* Refer to Rule #1.
13068 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
13069 @end enumerate
13070 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
13071 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
13072 @example
13073 #1 Good
13074 proc someproc @{@} @{
13075 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
13076 @}
13077 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
13078 #2 Good - no variables
13079 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
13080 #3 Good Curly Braces
13081 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
13082 puts "Time: [date]"
13083 @}
13084 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
13085 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
13086 @end example
13087 @enumerate
13088 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
13089 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
13090 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
13091 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
13092 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
13093 command.
13094 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
13095 @*There are 4 examples:
13096 @enumerate
13097 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
13098 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
13099 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
13100 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
13101 @end enumerate
13102
13103 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
13104 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
13105 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
13106
13107 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
13108 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
13109 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
13110 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
13111 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
13112 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
13113 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
13114 @end enumerate
13115 @subsection Global Variables
13116 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
13117 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
13118 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
13119 @example
13120 proc myproc @{ @} @{
13121 set y 0 #Local variable Y
13122 global x #Global variable X
13123 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
13124 @}
13125 @end example
13126 @section Other Tcl Hacks
13127 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
13128 @example
13129 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
13130 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
13131 # Create var name
13132 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
13133 # Make it a global
13134 global $vn
13135 # Set it.
13136 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
13137 @}
13138 @end example
13139 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
13140 @example
13141 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
13142 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
13143 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
13144 @}
13145 @end example
13146
13147 @node License
13148 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
13149 @include fdl.texi
13150
13151 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
13152 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
13153 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
13154 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
13155 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
13156 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
13157
13158 @printindex cp
13159
13160 @node Command and Driver Index
13161 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
13162 @printindex fn
13163
13164 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)